1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 49 #include <algorithm> 50 #include <cstring> 51 #include <functional> 52 #include <unordered_map> 53 54 using namespace clang; 55 using namespace sema; 56 57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 58 if (OwnedType) { 59 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 60 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 61 } 62 63 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 64 } 65 66 namespace { 67 68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 69 public: 70 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 71 bool AllowTemplates = false, 72 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 73 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 74 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 75 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 76 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 77 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 78 } 79 80 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 81 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 82 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 83 return false; 84 85 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 86 return AllowTemplates; 87 88 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 89 if (!IsType) 90 return false; 91 92 if (AllowNonTemplates) 93 return true; 94 95 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 96 // as a template or as a non-template. 97 if (AllowTemplates) { 98 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 99 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 100 return false; 101 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 102 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 103 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 104 } 105 106 return false; 107 } 108 109 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 110 } 111 112 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 113 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 114 } 115 116 private: 117 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 118 bool WantClassName; 119 bool AllowTemplates; 120 bool AllowNonTemplates; 121 }; 122 123 } // end anonymous namespace 124 125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 127 switch (Kind) { 128 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 129 // token kind is a valid type specifier 130 case tok::kw_short: 131 case tok::kw_long: 132 case tok::kw___int64: 133 case tok::kw___int128: 134 case tok::kw_signed: 135 case tok::kw_unsigned: 136 case tok::kw_void: 137 case tok::kw_char: 138 case tok::kw_int: 139 case tok::kw_half: 140 case tok::kw_float: 141 case tok::kw_double: 142 case tok::kw___bf16: 143 case tok::kw__Float16: 144 case tok::kw___float128: 145 case tok::kw___ibm128: 146 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 147 case tok::kw_bool: 148 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 149 case tok::kw___auto_type: 150 return true; 151 152 case tok::annot_typename: 153 case tok::kw_char16_t: 154 case tok::kw_char32_t: 155 case tok::kw_typeof: 156 case tok::annot_decltype: 157 case tok::kw_decltype: 158 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 159 160 case tok::kw_char8_t: 161 return getLangOpts().Char8; 162 163 default: 164 break; 165 } 166 167 return false; 168 } 169 170 namespace { 171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 172 NotFound, 173 FoundNonType, 174 FoundType 175 }; 176 } // end anonymous namespace 177 178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 179 /// dependent class. 180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 184 SourceLocation NameLoc, 185 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 186 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 187 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 188 // Look for type decls in base classes. 189 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 190 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 191 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 192 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 193 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 194 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 195 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 196 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 197 // templates. 198 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 199 continue; 200 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 201 if (!TD) 202 continue; 203 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 204 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 205 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 206 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 207 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 208 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 209 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 210 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 211 BaseRD = PS; 212 } 213 } 214 } 215 if (BaseRD) { 216 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 217 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 218 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 219 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 220 } 221 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 222 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 224 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 225 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 226 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 227 break; 228 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 229 break; 230 } 231 } 232 } 233 } 234 235 return FoundTypeDecl; 236 } 237 238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 239 const IdentifierInfo &II, 240 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 241 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 242 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 243 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 244 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 246 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 247 DC = DC->getParent()) { 248 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 249 // templates. 250 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 251 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 252 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 253 } 254 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 255 return nullptr; 256 257 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 258 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 259 // lookup during template instantiation. 260 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II; 261 262 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 263 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 264 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 265 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 266 267 CXXScopeSpec SS; 268 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 269 270 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 271 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 272 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 273 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 274 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 275 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 276 } 277 278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 279 /// return the declaration of that type. 280 /// 281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 287 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 288 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 289 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 290 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 291 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 292 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 293 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 294 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 295 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 296 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 297 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 298 299 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 300 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 301 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 302 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 303 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 305 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 306 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 307 308 if (!LookupCtx) { 309 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 310 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 311 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 312 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 313 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 314 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 315 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 316 // 317 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 318 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 319 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 320 return nullptr; 321 322 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 323 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 324 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 325 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 326 327 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 328 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 329 II, NameLoc); 330 return ParsedType::make(T); 331 } 332 333 return nullptr; 334 } 335 336 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 337 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 338 return nullptr; 339 } 340 341 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 342 // lookup for class-names. 343 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 344 LookupOrdinaryName; 345 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 346 if (LookupCtx) { 347 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 348 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 349 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 350 // nested-name-specifier. 351 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 352 353 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 354 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 355 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 356 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 357 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 358 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 359 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 360 LookupName(Result, S); 361 } 362 } else { 363 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 364 LookupName(Result, S); 365 366 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 367 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 368 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 369 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 370 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 371 return TypeInBase; 372 } 373 } 374 375 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 376 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 377 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 378 case LookupResult::NotFound: 379 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 380 if (CorrectedII) { 381 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 382 AllowDeducedTemplate); 383 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 384 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 385 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 386 TemplateTy Template; 387 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 388 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 389 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 390 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 391 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 392 if (SS && NNS) { 393 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 394 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 395 } 396 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 397 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 398 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 399 // is handled elsewhere). 400 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 401 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 402 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 403 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 404 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 405 IsCtorOrDtorName, 406 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 407 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 408 if (Ty) { 409 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 410 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 411 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 412 if (SS && NNS) 413 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 414 *CorrectedII = NewII; 415 return Ty; 416 } 417 } 418 } 419 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 420 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 421 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 422 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 423 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 424 return nullptr; 425 426 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 427 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 428 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 429 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 430 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 431 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 432 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 433 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 434 return nullptr; 435 } 436 437 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 438 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 439 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 440 NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 441 if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>( 442 RealRes) || 443 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) { 444 if (!IIDecl || 445 // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic. 446 RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) { 447 IIDecl = RealRes; 448 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res); 449 } 450 } 451 } 452 453 if (!IIDecl) { 454 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 455 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 456 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 457 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 458 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 459 // a type name. 460 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 461 return nullptr; 462 } 463 464 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 465 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 466 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 467 // perform the name lookup again. 468 break; 469 470 case LookupResult::Found: 471 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 472 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 473 break; 474 } 475 476 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 477 478 QualType T; 479 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 480 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 481 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 482 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 483 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 484 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 485 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 486 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 487 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 488 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 489 << &II << /*Type*/1; 490 491 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 492 493 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 494 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 495 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 496 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 497 if (!HasTrailingDot) 498 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 499 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl. 500 } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 501 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc); 502 // Recover with 'int' 503 T = Context.IntTy; 504 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 505 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 506 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) { 507 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD); 508 TemplateName Template = 509 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 510 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(), 511 false); 512 // Don't wrap in a further UsingType. 513 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 514 } 515 } 516 517 if (T.isNull()) { 518 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 519 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 520 return nullptr; 521 } 522 523 if (FoundUsingShadow) 524 T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T); 525 526 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 527 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 528 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 529 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 530 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 531 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 532 // Construct a type with type-source information. 533 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 534 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 535 536 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 537 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 538 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 539 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 540 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 541 } else { 542 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 543 } 544 } 545 546 return ParsedType::make(T); 547 } 548 549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 550 static NestedNameSpecifier * 551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 552 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 553 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 554 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 555 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 556 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 557 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 558 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 559 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 560 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 561 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 562 } 563 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 564 } 565 566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 569 /// correctly rejects. 570 static const CXXRecordDecl * 571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 572 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 573 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 574 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 575 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 576 return MD->getParent(); 577 } 578 return nullptr; 579 } 580 581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 582 SourceLocation NameLoc, 583 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 584 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 585 586 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 587 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 588 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 589 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 590 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 591 // lookup is retried. 592 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 593 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 594 // name specifiers. 595 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 596 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 597 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 598 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 599 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 600 // instantiation time. 601 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 602 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 603 604 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 605 // template instantiation. 606 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 607 << RD; 608 } else { 609 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 610 return ParsedType(); 611 } 612 613 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 614 615 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 616 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 617 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 618 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 619 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 620 621 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 622 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 623 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 624 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 625 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 626 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 627 } 628 629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 635 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 636 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 637 LookupName(R, S, false); 638 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 639 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 640 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 641 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 642 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 643 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 644 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 645 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 646 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 647 } 648 } 649 650 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 651 } 652 653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 657 /// @code 658 /// template<class T> class A { 659 /// public: 660 /// typedef int TYPE; 661 /// }; 662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 663 /// public: 664 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 665 /// }; 666 /// @endcode 667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 668 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 669 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 670 return true; 671 672 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 673 674 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 675 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 676 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 677 return true; 678 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 679 } 680 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 681 } 682 683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 684 SourceLocation IILoc, 685 Scope *S, 686 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 687 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 688 bool IsTemplateName) { 689 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 690 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 691 return; 692 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 693 SuggestedType = nullptr; 694 695 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 696 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 697 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 698 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 699 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 700 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 701 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 702 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 703 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 704 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 705 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 706 // We corrected to a keyword. 707 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 708 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 709 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 710 << II); 711 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 712 } else { 713 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 714 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 715 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 716 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 717 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 718 << II, CanRecover); 719 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 720 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 721 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 722 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 723 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 724 PDiag(IsTemplateName 725 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 726 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 727 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 728 CanRecover); 729 } else { 730 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 731 } 732 733 if (!CanRecover) 734 return; 735 736 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 737 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 738 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 739 SourceRange(IILoc)); 740 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 741 SuggestedType = 742 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 743 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 744 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 745 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 746 } 747 return; 748 } 749 750 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 751 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 752 UnqualifiedId Name; 753 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 754 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 755 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 756 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 757 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 758 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 759 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 760 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 761 return; 762 } 763 } 764 765 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 766 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 767 768 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 769 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 770 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 771 << II; 772 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 773 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 774 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 775 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 776 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 777 SuggestedType = 778 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 779 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 780 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 781 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 782 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 783 784 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 785 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 786 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 787 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 788 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 789 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 790 } else { 791 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 792 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 793 } 794 } 795 796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 797 /// or 798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 799 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 800 NextToken.is(tok::less); 801 802 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 803 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 804 return true; 805 806 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 807 return true; 808 } 809 810 return false; 811 } 812 813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 814 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 815 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 816 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 817 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 818 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 819 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 820 StringRef FixItTagName; 821 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 822 case TTK_Class: 823 FixItTagName = "class "; 824 break; 825 826 case TTK_Enum: 827 FixItTagName = "enum "; 828 break; 829 830 case TTK_Struct: 831 FixItTagName = "struct "; 832 break; 833 834 case TTK_Interface: 835 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 836 break; 837 838 case TTK_Union: 839 FixItTagName = "union "; 840 break; 841 } 842 843 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 844 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 845 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 847 848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 849 I != IEnd; ++I) 850 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 851 << Name << TagName; 852 853 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 854 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 855 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 856 return true; 857 } 858 859 return false; 860 } 861 862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 863 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 864 SourceLocation NameLoc, 865 const Token &NextToken, 866 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 867 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 868 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 869 870 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 871 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 872 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 873 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 874 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 875 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 876 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 877 // will reject it later. 878 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 879 } 880 881 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 882 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 883 884 if (SS.isInvalid()) 885 return NameClassification::Error(); 886 887 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 888 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 889 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 890 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 891 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 892 return TypeInBase; 893 } 894 895 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 896 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 897 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 898 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 899 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 900 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 901 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 902 return NameClassification::Error(); 903 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 904 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 905 906 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 907 if (Result.empty()) 908 LookupBuiltin(Result); 909 } 910 911 bool SecondTry = false; 912 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 913 914 Corrected: 915 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 916 case LookupResult::NotFound: 917 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 918 // call. 919 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 920 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 921 // FIXME: Reference? 922 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 923 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 924 925 // C90 6.3.2.2: 926 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 927 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 928 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 929 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 930 // the function call, the declaration 931 // 932 // extern int identifier (); 933 // 934 // appeared. 935 // 936 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not 937 // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not 938 // be supported. 939 if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) { 940 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 941 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 942 } 943 } 944 945 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 946 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 947 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 948 // 949 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 950 TemplateName Template = 951 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 952 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 953 } 954 955 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 956 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 957 // "struct", or "union". 958 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 959 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 960 break; 961 } 962 963 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 964 // close to this name. 965 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 966 SecondTry = true; 967 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 968 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 969 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 970 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 971 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 972 973 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 974 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 975 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 976 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 977 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 978 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 979 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 980 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 981 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 982 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 983 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 984 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 985 } 986 987 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 988 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 989 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 990 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 991 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 992 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 993 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 995 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 996 } 997 998 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 999 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 1000 1001 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 1002 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 1003 return Name; 1004 1005 // Also update the LookupResult... 1006 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 1007 Result.clear(); 1008 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1009 if (FirstDecl) 1010 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 1011 1012 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1013 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1014 // reference the ivar. 1015 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1016 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1017 DeclResult R = 1018 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1019 if (R.isInvalid()) 1020 return NameClassification::Error(); 1021 if (R.isUsable()) 1022 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1023 } 1024 1025 goto Corrected; 1026 } 1027 } 1028 1029 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1030 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1031 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1032 1033 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1034 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1035 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1036 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1037 1038 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1039 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1040 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1041 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1042 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1043 // 1044 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1045 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1046 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1047 // keyword here. 1048 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1049 } 1050 1051 case LookupResult::Found: 1052 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1053 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1054 break; 1055 1056 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1058 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1059 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1060 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1061 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1062 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1063 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1064 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1065 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1066 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1067 // ambiguous. 1068 // 1069 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1070 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1071 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1072 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1073 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1074 break; 1075 } 1076 } 1077 1078 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1079 return NameClassification::Error(); 1080 } 1081 1082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1083 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1084 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1085 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1086 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1087 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1088 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1089 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1090 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1091 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1092 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1093 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1094 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1095 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1096 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1097 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1098 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1099 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1100 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1101 1102 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1103 bool IsVarTemplate; 1104 TemplateName Template; 1105 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1106 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1107 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1108 Result.end()); 1109 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1110 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1111 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1112 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1113 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1114 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1115 1116 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = 1117 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 1118 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || 1119 TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl())); 1120 Template = 1121 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 1122 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1123 Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1124 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, 1125 Template); 1126 } else { 1127 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1128 // name. 1129 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1130 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1131 } 1132 1133 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1134 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1135 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1136 // to based on which function we selected. 1137 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1138 1139 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1140 } 1141 1142 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1143 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1144 } 1145 1146 auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) { 1147 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1148 if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 1149 T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T); 1150 1151 if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info 1152 return ParsedType::make(T); 1153 1154 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 1155 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 1156 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 1157 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 1158 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 1159 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 1160 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 1161 }; 1162 1163 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1164 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1165 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1166 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1167 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1168 } 1169 1170 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1171 if (!Class) { 1172 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1173 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1174 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1175 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1176 } 1177 1178 if (Class) { 1179 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1180 1181 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1182 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1183 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1184 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1185 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1186 } 1187 1188 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1189 return ParsedType::make(T); 1190 } 1191 1192 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1193 return NameClassification::Concept( 1194 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1195 1196 if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1197 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc); 1198 return NameClassification::Error(); 1199 } 1200 1201 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1202 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1203 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1204 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1205 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1206 1207 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1208 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1209 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1210 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1211 (NextIsOp && 1212 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1213 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1214 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1215 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1216 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1217 } 1218 1219 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1220 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1221 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1222 // the context. 1223 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1224 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1225 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1226 1227 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1228 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1229 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1230 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1231 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1232 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1233 } 1234 1235 ExprResult 1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1237 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1238 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1239 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1240 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1241 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1242 } 1243 1244 ExprResult 1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1246 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1247 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1248 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1249 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1250 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1251 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1252 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1253 } 1254 1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1256 NamedDecl *Found, 1257 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1258 const Token &NextToken) { 1259 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1260 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1261 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1262 1263 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1264 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1265 Result.addDecl(Found); 1266 Result.resolveKind(); 1267 1268 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1269 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1270 } 1271 1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1273 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1274 // access expression if necessary. 1275 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1276 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1277 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1278 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1279 1280 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1281 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1282 LookupOrdinaryName); 1283 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1284 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1285 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1286 Result.resolveKind(); 1287 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1288 nullptr, S); 1289 } 1290 1291 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1292 // are necessary. 1293 return ULE; 1294 } 1295 1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1298 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1299 if (!TD) 1300 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1301 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1302 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1303 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1304 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1305 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1306 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1307 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1308 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1309 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1310 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1311 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1312 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1313 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1314 } 1315 1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1317 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1318 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1319 CurContext = DC; 1320 S->setEntity(DC); 1321 } 1322 1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1324 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1325 1326 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1327 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1328 } 1329 1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1331 Decl *D) { 1332 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1333 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1334 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1335 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1336 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1337 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1338 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1339 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1340 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1341 return Result; 1342 } 1343 1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1345 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1346 } 1347 1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1350 /// 1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1352 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1353 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1354 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1355 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1356 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1357 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1358 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1359 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1360 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1361 // namespace. 1362 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1363 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1364 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1365 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1366 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1367 1368 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1369 1370 #ifndef NDEBUG 1371 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1372 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1373 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1374 #endif 1375 1376 CurContext = DC; 1377 S->setEntity(DC); 1378 1379 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1380 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1381 // template parameter scopes. 1382 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1383 } 1384 } 1385 1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1387 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1388 1389 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1390 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1391 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1392 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1393 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1394 1395 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1396 // disappear. 1397 } 1398 1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1400 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1401 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1402 1403 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1404 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1405 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1406 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1407 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1408 // class or function template). 1409 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1410 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1411 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1412 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1413 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1414 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1415 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1416 // 1417 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1418 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1419 // scope. For example, for 1420 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1421 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1422 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1423 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1424 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1425 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1426 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1427 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1428 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1429 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1430 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1431 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1432 continue; 1433 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1434 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1435 break; 1436 } 1437 } 1438 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1439 } 1440 } 1441 1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1443 // We assume that the caller has already called 1444 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1445 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1446 if (!FD) 1447 return; 1448 1449 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1450 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1451 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1452 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1453 CurContext = FD; 1454 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1455 1456 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1457 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1458 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1459 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1460 S->AddDecl(Param); 1461 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1462 } 1463 } 1464 } 1465 1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1467 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1468 // rather than the top-level class. 1469 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1470 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1471 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1472 } 1473 1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function 1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name. 1476 /// 1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one. 1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted) 1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a 1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute. 1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous, 1483 ASTContext &Context, 1484 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1485 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 1486 return true; 1487 1488 // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the 1489 // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an 1490 // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function 1491 // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore 1492 // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had 1493 // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one 1494 // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary 1495 // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that 1496 // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations 1497 // that were required to have it but did not. 1498 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) { 1499 return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 1500 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1501 }); 1502 } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 1503 return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1504 1505 return false; 1506 } 1507 1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1510 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1511 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1512 // scope. 1513 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1514 S = S->getParent(); 1515 1516 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1517 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1518 // into any context. 1519 if (AddToContext) 1520 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1521 1522 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1523 // are function-local declarations. 1524 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1525 return; 1526 1527 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1528 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1529 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1530 return; 1531 1532 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1533 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1534 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1535 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1536 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1537 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1538 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1539 1540 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1541 break; 1542 } 1543 } 1544 1545 S->AddDecl(D); 1546 1547 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1548 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1549 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1550 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1551 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1552 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1553 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1554 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1555 continue; 1556 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1557 break; 1558 } 1559 1560 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1561 } else { 1562 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1563 } 1564 warnOnReservedIdentifier(D); 1565 } 1566 1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1568 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1569 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1570 } 1571 1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1573 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1574 do { 1575 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1576 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1577 return S; 1578 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1579 1580 return nullptr; 1581 } 1582 1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1584 DeclContext*, 1585 ASTContext&); 1586 1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1590 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1591 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1592 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1593 while (F.hasNext()) { 1594 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1595 1596 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1597 continue; 1598 1599 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1600 continue; 1601 1602 F.erase(); 1603 } 1604 1605 F.done(); 1606 } 1607 1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1609 /// have compatible owning modules. 1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1611 // [module.interface]p7: 1612 // A declaration is attached to a module as follows: 1613 // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a 1614 // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that 1615 // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither 1616 // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the 1617 // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]). 1618 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1619 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1620 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1621 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1622 return false; 1623 } 1624 1625 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1626 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1627 1628 if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1629 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1630 if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1631 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1632 1633 // If we have a decl in a module partition, it is part of the containing 1634 // module (which is the only thing that can be importing it). 1635 if (NewM && OldM && 1636 (OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionInterface || 1637 OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionImplementation)) { 1638 return false; 1639 } 1640 1641 if (NewM == OldM) 1642 return false; 1643 1644 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1645 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1646 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1647 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1648 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1649 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1650 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1651 << New 1652 << NewIsModuleInterface 1653 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1654 << OldIsModuleInterface 1655 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1656 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1657 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1658 return true; 1659 } 1660 1661 return false; 1662 } 1663 1664 // [module.interface]p6: 1665 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by 1666 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported. 1667 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1668 // [module.interface]p1: 1669 // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope. 1670 // 1671 // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace 1672 // scope. 1673 if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext() 1674 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1675 ->isFileContext() || 1676 !Old->getLexicalDeclContext() 1677 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1678 ->isFileContext()) 1679 return false; 1680 1681 bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext(); 1682 bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext(); 1683 1684 // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported. 1685 if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported) 1686 return false; 1687 1688 if (IsOldExported) 1689 return false; 1690 1691 assert(IsNewExported); 1692 1693 auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage(); 1694 int S = 0; 1695 if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage) 1696 S = 1; 1697 else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage) 1698 S = 2; 1699 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S; 1700 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1701 return true; 1702 } 1703 1704 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of 1705 // a redeclaration within a module. 1706 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1707 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 1708 return true; 1709 1710 if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old)) 1711 return true; 1712 1713 return false; 1714 } 1715 1716 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1717 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1718 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1719 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1720 } 1721 1722 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1723 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1724 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1725 while (F.hasNext()) 1726 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1727 F.erase(); 1728 1729 F.done(); 1730 } 1731 1732 /// Check for this common pattern: 1733 /// @code 1734 /// class S { 1735 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1736 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1737 /// }; 1738 /// @endcode 1739 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1740 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1741 // the decl here. 1742 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1743 return false; 1744 1745 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1746 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1747 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1748 } 1749 1750 // We need this to handle 1751 // 1752 // typedef struct { 1753 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1754 // } A; 1755 // 1756 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1757 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1758 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1759 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1760 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1761 // not. 1762 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1763 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1764 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1765 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1766 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1767 return true; 1768 } 1769 DC = DC->getParent(); 1770 } 1771 1772 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1773 } 1774 1775 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1776 // these semantics. 1777 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1778 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1779 return false; 1780 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1781 } 1782 1783 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1784 assert(D); 1785 1786 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1787 return false; 1788 1789 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1790 // of members of class templates. 1791 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1792 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1793 return false; 1794 1795 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1796 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1797 return false; 1798 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1799 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1800 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1801 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1802 return false; 1803 1804 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1805 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1806 return false; 1807 } else { 1808 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1809 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1810 return false; 1811 } 1812 1813 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1814 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1815 return false; 1816 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1817 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1818 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1819 // like "inline".) 1820 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1821 return false; 1822 1823 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1824 return false; 1825 1826 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1827 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1828 return false; 1829 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1830 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1831 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1832 return false; 1833 1834 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1835 return false; 1836 } else { 1837 return false; 1838 } 1839 1840 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1841 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1842 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1843 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1844 } 1845 1846 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1847 if (!D) 1848 return; 1849 1850 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1851 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1852 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1853 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1854 } 1855 1856 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1857 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1858 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1859 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1860 } 1861 1862 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1863 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1864 } 1865 1866 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1867 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1868 return false; 1869 1870 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1871 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1872 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1873 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1874 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1875 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1876 return false; 1877 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1878 return false; 1879 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1880 return false; 1881 } 1882 1883 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1884 return false; 1885 1886 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1887 return true; 1888 1889 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1890 // functions. 1891 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1892 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1893 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1894 WithinFunction = 1895 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1896 if (!WithinFunction) 1897 return false; 1898 1899 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1900 return true; 1901 1902 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1903 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1904 return false; 1905 1906 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1907 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1908 1909 const Expr *Init = VD->getInit(); 1910 if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1911 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1912 1913 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1914 1915 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1916 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1917 // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)). 1918 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1919 return false; 1920 } 1921 1922 // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime 1923 // extension. 1924 if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) { 1925 if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) { 1926 Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr(); 1927 Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten(); 1928 } 1929 } 1930 1931 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1932 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1933 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1934 return false; 1935 1936 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 1937 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 1938 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1939 1940 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1941 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1942 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1943 return false; 1944 1945 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1946 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1947 return false; 1948 1949 if (Init) { 1950 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1951 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1952 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1953 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1954 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 1955 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 1956 return false; 1957 } 1958 1959 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 1960 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 1961 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) { 1962 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 1963 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 1964 return false; 1965 } 1966 1967 // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because 1968 // its arguments are dependent. 1969 if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init)) 1970 return false; 1971 } 1972 } 1973 } 1974 1975 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1976 } 1977 1978 return true; 1979 } 1980 1981 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1982 FixItHint &Hint) { 1983 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1984 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 1985 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 1986 true); 1987 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1988 return; 1989 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 1990 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 1991 } 1992 } 1993 1994 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1995 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1996 return; 1997 1998 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1999 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 2000 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 2001 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 2002 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 2003 } 2004 } 2005 2006 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 2007 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 2008 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 2009 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 2010 return; 2011 2012 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2013 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 2014 // at end-of-translation-unit. 2015 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 2016 return; 2017 } 2018 2019 FixItHint Hint; 2020 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 2021 2022 unsigned DiagID; 2023 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 2024 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 2025 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 2026 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 2027 else 2028 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 2029 2030 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 2031 } 2032 2033 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) { 2034 // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute, 2035 // it's not really unused. 2036 if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || 2037 VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>()) 2038 return; 2039 2040 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2041 2042 if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 2043 return; 2044 2045 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 2046 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 2047 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 2048 return; 2049 // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to 2050 // mimic gcc's behavior. 2051 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 2052 if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 2053 return; 2054 } 2055 } 2056 2057 // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might 2058 // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime 2059 // extension. 2060 if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2061 return; 2062 2063 // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime 2064 // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known 2065 // time, which may mean assignment but no other references. 2066 if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2067 return; 2068 2069 auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD); 2070 if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end()) 2071 return; 2072 2073 assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 && 2074 "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl"); 2075 if (iter->getSecond() != 0) 2076 return; 2077 unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter 2078 : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable; 2079 Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD; 2080 } 2081 2082 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 2083 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 2084 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 2085 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 2086 // MS inline assembly label name. 2087 bool Diagnose = false; 2088 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 2089 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 2090 else 2091 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 2092 if (Diagnose) 2093 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 2094 } 2095 2096 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 2097 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 2098 2099 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 2100 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 2101 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 2102 2103 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 2104 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 2105 2106 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 2107 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 2108 2109 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 2110 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 2111 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 2112 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 2113 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 2114 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2115 DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD); 2116 RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD); 2117 } 2118 } 2119 2120 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 2121 2122 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 2123 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 2124 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 2125 2126 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 2127 // already. 2128 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 2129 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 2130 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 2131 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 2132 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 2133 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 2134 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2135 } 2136 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 2137 } 2138 } 2139 } 2140 2141 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 2142 /// 2143 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 2144 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 2145 /// to the fixed name. 2146 /// 2147 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 2148 /// 2149 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 2150 /// if there is no class with the given name. 2151 /// 2152 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 2153 /// class could not be found. 2154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 2155 SourceLocation IdLoc, 2156 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 2157 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 2158 // creation from this context. 2159 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 2160 2161 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 2162 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 2163 // find an Objective-C class name. 2164 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 2165 if (TypoCorrection C = 2166 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 2167 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 2168 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 2169 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 2170 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 2171 } 2172 } 2173 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 2174 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 2175 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2176 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2177 return Def; 2178 } 2179 2180 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2181 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2182 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2183 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2184 /// ill-formed in C++: 2185 /// @code 2186 /// struct S6 { 2187 /// enum { BAR } e; 2188 /// }; 2189 /// 2190 /// void test_S6() { 2191 /// struct S6 a; 2192 /// a.e = BAR; 2193 /// } 2194 /// @endcode 2195 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2196 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2197 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2198 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2199 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2200 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2201 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2202 /// contain non-field names. 2203 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2204 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2205 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2206 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2207 S = S->getParent(); 2208 return S; 2209 } 2210 2211 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2212 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2213 switch (Error) { 2214 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2215 return ""; 2216 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2217 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2218 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2219 return "stdio.h"; 2220 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2221 return "setjmp.h"; 2222 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2223 return "ucontext.h"; 2224 } 2225 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2226 } 2227 2228 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2229 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2230 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2231 2232 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2233 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2234 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2235 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2236 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2237 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2238 } 2239 2240 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2241 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, 2242 getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 2243 false, Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2244 New->setImplicit(); 2245 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2246 2247 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2248 // FunctionDecl. 2249 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2250 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2251 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2252 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2253 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2254 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2255 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2256 Params.push_back(parm); 2257 } 2258 New->setParams(Params); 2259 } 2260 2261 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2262 return New; 2263 } 2264 2265 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2266 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2267 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2268 /// built-in. 2269 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2270 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2271 SourceLocation Loc) { 2272 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2273 2274 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2275 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2276 if (Error) { 2277 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2278 return nullptr; 2279 2280 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2281 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2282 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2283 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2284 return nullptr; 2285 2286 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2287 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2288 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2289 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2290 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2291 return nullptr; 2292 } 2293 2294 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2295 // appropriate header. 2296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2297 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2298 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2299 return nullptr; 2300 } 2301 2302 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2303 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2305 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99 2306 : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2307 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2308 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2309 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2310 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2311 } 2312 2313 if (R.isNull()) 2314 return nullptr; 2315 2316 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2317 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2318 2319 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2320 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2321 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2322 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2323 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2324 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2325 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2326 CurContext = SavedContext; 2327 return New; 2328 } 2329 2330 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2331 /// entity if their types are the same. 2332 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2333 /// isSameEntity. 2334 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2335 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2336 LookupResult &Previous) { 2337 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2338 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2339 return; 2340 2341 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2342 if (Previous.empty()) 2343 return; 2344 2345 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2346 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2347 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2348 2349 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2350 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2351 continue; 2352 2353 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2354 // different linkages. 2355 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2356 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2357 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2358 continue; 2359 2360 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2361 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2362 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2363 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2364 continue; 2365 } 2366 2367 Filter.erase(); 2368 } 2369 2370 Filter.done(); 2371 } 2372 2373 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2374 QualType OldType; 2375 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2376 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2377 else 2378 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2379 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2380 2381 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2382 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2383 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2384 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2385 << Kind << NewType; 2386 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2387 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2388 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2389 return true; 2390 } 2391 2392 if (OldType != NewType && 2393 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2394 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2395 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2396 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2397 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2398 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2399 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2400 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2401 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2402 return true; 2403 } 2404 return false; 2405 } 2406 2407 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2408 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2409 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2410 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2411 /// 2412 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2413 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2414 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2415 // merging checks. 2416 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2417 2418 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2419 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2420 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2421 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2422 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2423 default: break; 2424 case 2: 2425 { 2426 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2427 break; 2428 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2429 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2430 break; 2431 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2432 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2433 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2434 break; 2435 } 2436 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2437 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2438 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2439 return; 2440 } 2441 case 5: 2442 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2443 break; 2444 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2445 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2446 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2447 return; 2448 case 3: 2449 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2450 break; 2451 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2452 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2453 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2454 return; 2455 } 2456 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2457 } 2458 2459 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2460 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2461 if (!Old) { 2462 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2463 << New->getDeclName(); 2464 2465 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2466 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2467 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2468 2469 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2470 } 2471 2472 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2473 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2474 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2475 2476 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2477 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2478 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2479 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2480 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2481 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2482 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2483 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2484 // instead of our tag. 2485 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2486 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2487 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2488 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2489 else 2490 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2491 2492 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2493 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2494 2495 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2496 // out of the scope. 2497 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2498 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2499 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2500 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2501 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2502 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2503 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2504 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2505 } 2506 } 2507 } 2508 } 2509 2510 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2511 // with any extensions enabled. 2512 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2513 return; 2514 2515 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2516 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2517 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2518 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2519 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2520 } 2521 2522 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2523 return; 2524 2525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2526 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2527 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2528 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2529 // to the type to which it already refers. 2530 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2531 return; 2532 2533 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2534 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2535 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2536 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2537 // 2538 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2539 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2540 // 2541 // struct S { 2542 // typedef struct A { } A; 2543 // }; 2544 // 2545 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2546 // allow the above but disallow 2547 // 2548 // struct S { 2549 // typedef int I; 2550 // typedef int I; 2551 // }; 2552 // 2553 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2554 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2555 return; 2556 2557 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2558 << New->getDeclName(); 2559 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2560 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2561 } 2562 2563 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2564 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2565 return; 2566 2567 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2568 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2569 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2570 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2571 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2572 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2573 (Old->isImplicit() || 2574 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2575 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2576 return; 2577 2578 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2579 << New->getDeclName(); 2580 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2581 } 2582 2583 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2584 /// attribute. 2585 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2586 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2587 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2588 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2589 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2590 if (Ann) { 2591 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2592 return true; 2593 continue; 2594 } 2595 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2596 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2597 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2598 return true; 2599 } 2600 2601 return false; 2602 } 2603 2604 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2605 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2606 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2607 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2608 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2609 return true; 2610 } 2611 2612 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2613 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2614 /// 2615 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2616 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2617 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2618 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2619 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2620 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2621 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2622 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2623 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2624 // in a case like: 2625 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2626 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2627 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2628 // definition in such a case. 2629 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2630 return false; 2631 2632 if (I->isAlignas()) 2633 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2634 2635 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2636 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2637 OldAlign = Align; 2638 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2639 } 2640 } 2641 2642 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2643 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2644 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2645 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2646 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2647 return false; 2648 2649 if (I->isAlignas()) 2650 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2651 2652 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2653 if (Align > NewAlign) 2654 NewAlign = Align; 2655 } 2656 2657 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2658 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2659 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2660 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2661 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2662 2663 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2664 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2665 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2666 QualType Ty; 2667 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2668 Ty = VD->getType(); 2669 else 2670 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2671 2672 if (OldAlign == 0) 2673 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2674 if (NewAlign == 0) 2675 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2676 } 2677 2678 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2679 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2680 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2681 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2682 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2683 } 2684 } 2685 2686 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2687 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2688 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2689 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2690 // equivalent alignment. 2691 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2692 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2693 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2694 // have no alignment specifier. 2695 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2696 << OldAlignasAttr; 2697 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2698 << OldAlignasAttr; 2699 } 2700 2701 bool AnyAdded = false; 2702 2703 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2704 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2705 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2706 Clone->setInherited(true); 2707 New->addAttr(Clone); 2708 AnyAdded = true; 2709 } 2710 2711 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2712 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2713 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2714 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2715 Clone->setInherited(true); 2716 New->addAttr(Clone); 2717 AnyAdded = true; 2718 } 2719 2720 return AnyAdded; 2721 } 2722 2723 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2724 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc" 2725 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2726 2727 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2728 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2729 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2730 // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add 2731 // and attributes that already exist on the declaration. 2732 if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr)) 2733 return false; 2734 2735 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2736 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2737 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2738 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2739 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2740 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2741 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2742 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2743 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2744 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2745 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2746 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2747 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2748 AA->getPriority()); 2749 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2750 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2751 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2752 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2753 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2754 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2755 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2756 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2757 else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr)) 2758 NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic()); 2759 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2760 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2761 FA->getFirstArg()); 2762 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2763 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2764 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2765 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2766 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2767 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2768 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2769 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2770 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2771 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2772 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2773 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2774 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2775 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2776 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2777 return false; 2778 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2779 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2780 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2781 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2782 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2783 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2784 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2785 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2786 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2787 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2788 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2789 NewAttr = nullptr; 2790 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2791 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2792 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation || 2793 AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation)) 2794 NewAttr = nullptr; 2795 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2796 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2797 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2798 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2799 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2800 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2801 else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr)) 2802 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA); 2803 else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr)) 2804 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA); 2805 else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr)) 2806 NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA); 2807 else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr)) 2808 NewAttr = 2809 S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ()); 2810 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr)) 2811 NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType()); 2812 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2813 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2814 2815 if (NewAttr) { 2816 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2817 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2818 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2819 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2820 return true; 2821 } 2822 2823 return false; 2824 } 2825 2826 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2827 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2828 return TD->getDefinition(); 2829 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2830 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2831 if (Def) 2832 return Def; 2833 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2834 } 2835 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2836 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2837 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2838 return Def; 2839 } 2840 return nullptr; 2841 } 2842 2843 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2844 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2845 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2846 return true; 2847 return false; 2848 } 2849 2850 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2851 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2852 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2853 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2854 return; 2855 2856 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2857 if (!Def || Def == New) 2858 return; 2859 2860 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2861 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2862 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2863 2864 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2865 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2866 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2867 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2868 2869 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2870 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2871 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2872 --E; 2873 continue; 2874 } 2875 } else { 2876 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2877 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2878 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2879 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2880 : diag::err_redefinition; 2881 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2882 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2883 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2884 else 2885 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2886 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2887 } 2888 ++I; 2889 continue; 2890 } 2891 2892 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2893 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2894 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2895 ++I; 2896 continue; 2897 } 2898 } 2899 2900 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2901 ++I; 2902 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2903 } 2904 2905 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2906 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2907 ++I; 2908 continue; 2909 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2910 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2911 ++I; 2912 continue; 2913 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2914 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2915 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2916 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2917 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2918 // equivalent alignment. 2919 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2920 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2921 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2922 // have no alignment specifier. 2923 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2924 << AA; 2925 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2926 << AA; 2927 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2928 --E; 2929 continue; 2930 } 2931 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2932 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 2933 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 2934 // standard diagnostics. 2935 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2936 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2937 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 2938 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2939 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2940 --E; 2941 continue; 2942 } 2943 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 2944 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 2945 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 2946 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 2947 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 2948 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 2949 // honored it. 2950 ++I; 2951 continue; 2952 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2953 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 2954 // declarations after defintions. 2955 ++I; 2956 continue; 2957 } 2958 2959 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2960 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2961 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2962 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2963 --E; 2964 } 2965 } 2966 2967 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 2968 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 2969 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 2970 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 2971 2972 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 2973 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 2974 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 2975 // heroics. 2976 std::string SuitableSpelling; 2977 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2978 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 2979 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 2980 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2981 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2982 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 2983 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 2984 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2985 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 2986 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2987 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2988 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 2989 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2990 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 2991 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2992 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 2993 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2994 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 2995 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2996 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 2997 SuitableSpelling += " "; 2998 2999 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 3000 // extern constinit int a; 3001 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 3002 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 3003 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 3004 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3005 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 3006 } else { 3007 // int a = 0; 3008 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 3009 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 3010 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 3011 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 3012 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 3013 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 3014 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 3015 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3016 } 3017 } 3018 3019 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 3020 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 3021 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 3022 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 3023 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3024 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3025 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3026 } 3027 if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 3028 RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3029 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3030 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3031 } 3032 3033 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 3034 return; 3035 3036 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 3037 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 3038 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 3039 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3040 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3041 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 3042 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 3043 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 3044 3045 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 3046 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 3047 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 3048 if (!InitDecl && 3049 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 3050 InitDecl = NewVD; 3051 3052 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 3053 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 3054 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 3055 // form). 3056 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 3057 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 3058 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 3059 } else if (NewConstInit) { 3060 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 3061 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 3062 // declaration, this is too late. 3063 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 3064 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 3065 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 3066 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3067 } 3068 } 3069 } 3070 3071 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 3072 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 3073 3074 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3075 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3076 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 3077 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 3078 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 3079 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3080 } 3081 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 3082 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 3083 // already been ODR-used. 3084 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 3085 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 3086 } 3087 } 3088 3089 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 3090 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3091 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3092 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 3093 if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) { 3094 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 3095 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 3096 << NewTag; 3097 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3098 } 3099 } 3100 } else { 3101 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 3102 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3103 } 3104 } 3105 3106 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 3107 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 3108 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 3109 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 3110 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 3111 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3112 } 3113 } 3114 } 3115 3116 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 3117 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 3118 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 3119 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 3120 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 3121 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 3122 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3123 } 3124 3125 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 3126 return; 3127 3128 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 3129 3130 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 3131 // we process them. 3132 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3133 3134 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 3135 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 3136 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 3137 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 3138 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 3139 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 3140 switch (AMK) { 3141 case AMK_None: 3142 continue; 3143 3144 case AMK_Redeclaration: 3145 case AMK_Override: 3146 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 3147 case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation: 3148 LocalAMK = AMK; 3149 break; 3150 } 3151 } 3152 3153 // Already handled. 3154 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I)) 3155 continue; 3156 3157 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 3158 foundAny = true; 3159 } 3160 3161 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 3162 foundAny = true; 3163 3164 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 3165 } 3166 3167 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 3168 /// to the new one. 3169 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 3170 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 3171 Sema &S) { 3172 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3173 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3174 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3175 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3176 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3177 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3178 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3179 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3180 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 3181 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 3182 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 3183 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 3184 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 3185 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 3186 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 3187 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3188 } 3189 3190 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 3191 return; 3192 3193 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 3194 3195 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 3196 // done before we process them. 3197 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3198 3199 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3200 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3201 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3202 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3203 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3204 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3205 foundAny = true; 3206 } 3207 } 3208 3209 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3210 } 3211 3212 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3213 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3214 Sema &S) { 3215 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3216 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3217 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3218 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3219 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3220 *Newnullability, 3221 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3222 != 0)) 3223 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3224 *Oldnullability, 3225 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3226 != 0)); 3227 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3228 } 3229 } else { 3230 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3231 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3232 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3233 NewT, NewT); 3234 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3235 } 3236 } 3237 } 3238 3239 namespace { 3240 3241 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3242 /// C. 3243 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3244 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3245 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3246 QualType PromotedType; 3247 }; 3248 3249 } // end anonymous namespace 3250 3251 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3252 // declaration, or a declaration. 3253 template <typename T> 3254 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3255 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3256 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3257 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3258 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3259 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3260 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3261 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3262 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) { 3263 if (FD->getBuiltinID()) 3264 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3265 } 3266 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3267 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3268 } else 3269 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3270 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3271 } 3272 3273 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3274 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3275 /// GNU89 mode. 3276 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3277 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3278 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3279 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3280 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3281 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3282 } 3283 3284 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3285 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3286 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3287 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3288 return AT; 3289 } 3290 3291 template <typename T> 3292 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3293 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3294 if (DC->isRecord()) 3295 return false; 3296 3297 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3298 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3299 return true; 3300 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3301 return true; 3302 return false; 3303 } 3304 3305 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3306 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3307 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3308 3309 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3310 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3311 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3312 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3313 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3314 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3315 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3316 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3317 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3318 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3319 // and function templates; or 3320 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3321 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3322 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3323 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3324 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3325 3326 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3327 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3328 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3329 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3330 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3331 3332 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3333 if (Old && 3334 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3335 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3336 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3337 Old = nullptr; 3338 3339 if (!Old) { 3340 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3341 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3342 S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3343 return true; 3344 } 3345 return false; 3346 } 3347 3348 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3349 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3350 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3351 3352 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3353 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3354 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3355 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3356 return true; 3357 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3358 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3359 }; 3360 3361 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3362 } 3363 3364 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3365 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3366 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3367 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3368 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3369 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3370 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3371 // 3372 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3373 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3374 // 3375 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3376 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3377 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3378 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3379 return; 3380 3381 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3382 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3383 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3384 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3385 return; 3386 3387 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3388 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3389 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3390 3391 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3392 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3393 if (!D) 3394 return; 3395 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3396 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3397 }; 3398 3399 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3400 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3401 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3402 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3403 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3404 } 3405 3406 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3407 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3408 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3409 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3410 /// 3411 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3412 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3413 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3414 /// merged with. 3415 /// 3416 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3417 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S, 3418 bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) { 3419 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3420 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3421 if (!Old) { 3422 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3423 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3424 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3425 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3426 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3427 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 3428 << 0; 3429 return true; 3430 } 3431 3432 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or 3433 // function template. 3434 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = 3435 New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 3436 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, 3437 NewTemplate)) 3438 return true; 3439 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()) 3440 ->getAsFunction(); 3441 } else { 3442 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3443 return true; 3444 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3445 } 3446 } else { 3447 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3448 << New->getDeclName(); 3449 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3450 return true; 3451 } 3452 } 3453 3454 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 3455 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 3456 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 3457 3458 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3459 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3460 return true; 3461 3462 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3463 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3464 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3465 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3466 << Old << Old->getType(); 3467 return true; 3468 } 3469 3470 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3471 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3472 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3473 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3474 3475 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3476 // is an extern inline function. 3477 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3478 // storage classes. 3479 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3480 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3481 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3482 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3483 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3484 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3485 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3486 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3487 } else { 3488 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3489 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3490 return true; 3491 } 3492 } 3493 3494 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 3495 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3496 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3497 << ILA; 3498 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3499 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3500 } 3501 3502 if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3503 if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3504 Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA; 3505 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3506 New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>(); 3507 } 3508 } 3509 3510 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 3511 return true; 3512 3513 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3514 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3515 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3516 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3517 << New << OldOvl; 3518 3519 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3520 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3521 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3522 // 3523 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3524 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3525 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3526 if (OldOvl) { 3527 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3528 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3529 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3530 }); 3531 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3532 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3533 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3534 } 3535 3536 if (DiagOld) 3537 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3538 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3539 << OldOvl; 3540 3541 if (OldOvl) 3542 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3543 else 3544 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3545 } 3546 } 3547 3548 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3549 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3550 // convention of the first. 3551 // 3552 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3553 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3554 // 3555 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3556 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3557 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3558 // 3559 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3560 // other tests to run. 3561 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3562 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3563 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3564 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3565 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3566 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3567 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3568 3569 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3570 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3571 const FunctionType *FT = 3572 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3573 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3574 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3575 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3576 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3577 // there but not here. 3578 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3579 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3580 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3581 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3582 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3583 3584 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3585 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3586 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3587 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3588 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3589 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3590 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3591 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3592 } else { 3593 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3594 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3595 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3596 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3597 << !FirstCCExplicit 3598 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3599 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3600 3601 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3602 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3603 return true; 3604 } 3605 } 3606 3607 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3608 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3609 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3610 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3611 } 3612 3613 // Merge regparm attribute. 3614 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3615 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3616 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3617 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3618 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3619 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3620 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3621 return true; 3622 } 3623 3624 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3625 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3626 } 3627 3628 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3629 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3630 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3631 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3632 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3633 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3634 return true; 3635 } 3636 3637 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3638 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3639 } 3640 3641 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3642 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3643 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3644 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3645 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3646 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3647 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3648 return true; 3649 } 3650 3651 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3652 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3653 } 3654 3655 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3656 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3657 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3658 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3659 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3660 } 3661 3662 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3663 // UndefinedButUsed. 3664 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3665 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3666 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3667 Old->isUsed(false) && 3668 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3669 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3670 SourceLocation())); 3671 3672 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3673 // about it. 3674 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3675 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3676 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3677 } 3678 3679 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3680 // redeclaration. 3681 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3682 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3683 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3684 << New->getDeclName(); 3685 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3686 return true; 3687 } 3688 3689 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3690 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3691 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3692 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3693 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3694 3695 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3696 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3697 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3698 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3699 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3700 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3701 return true; 3702 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3703 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3704 3705 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3706 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3707 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3708 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3709 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3710 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3711 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3712 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3713 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3714 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3715 QualType ResQT; 3716 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3717 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3718 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3719 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3720 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3721 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3722 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3723 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3724 else 3725 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3726 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3727 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3728 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3729 return true; 3730 } 3731 else 3732 NewQType = ResQT; 3733 } 3734 3735 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3736 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3737 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3738 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3739 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3740 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3741 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3742 QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType(); 3743 if (DT.isNull()) { 3744 New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType())); 3745 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType)); 3746 } else { 3747 New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT)); 3748 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT)); 3749 } 3750 } 3751 } 3752 3753 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3754 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3755 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3756 // Preserve triviality. 3757 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3758 3759 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3760 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3761 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3762 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3763 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3764 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3765 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3766 3767 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3768 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3769 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3770 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3771 // is a static member function declaration. 3772 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3773 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3774 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3775 return true; 3776 } 3777 3778 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3779 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3780 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3781 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3782 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3783 unsigned NewDiag; 3784 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3785 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3786 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3787 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3788 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3789 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3790 else 3791 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3792 3793 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3794 } else { 3795 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3796 << New << New->getType(); 3797 } 3798 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3799 return true; 3800 3801 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3802 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3803 // 3804 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3805 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3806 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3807 if (isFriend) { 3808 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3809 } else { 3810 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3811 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3812 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3813 return true; 3814 } 3815 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3816 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3817 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3818 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3819 return true; 3820 } 3821 } 3822 3823 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3824 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3825 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3826 // attribute. 3827 if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) 3828 if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3829 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3830 << NRA; 3831 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3832 } 3833 3834 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3835 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3836 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3837 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3838 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3839 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3840 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3841 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3842 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3843 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3844 } 3845 3846 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3847 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3848 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3849 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3850 3851 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3852 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3853 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3854 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3855 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3856 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3857 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3858 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3859 } 3860 3861 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3862 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3863 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3864 // 3865 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3866 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3867 // linkage within class scope. 3868 // 3869 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3870 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3871 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3872 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3873 } else { 3874 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3875 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3876 return true; 3877 } 3878 } 3879 3880 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 3881 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 3882 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 3883 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 3884 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 3885 NewQType)) 3886 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3887 3888 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 3889 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 3890 // during instantiation. 3891 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 3892 return false; 3893 3894 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 3895 } 3896 3897 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 3898 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 3899 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3900 // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other 3901 // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly 3902 // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters 3903 // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that 3904 // results from the application of default argument promotions to the 3905 // type of the corresponding identifier. ... 3906 // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that 3907 // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when 3908 // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation 3909 // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the 3910 // default argument promotion rules were already checked by 3911 // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(). 3912 if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn && 3913 Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams()) { 3914 if (Old->hasInheritedPrototype()) 3915 Old = Old->getCanonicalDecl(); 3916 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New; 3917 Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3918 return true; 3919 } 3920 3921 // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype, 3922 // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the 3923 // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles 3924 // cases like: 3925 // void i(); void i(int j); 3926 // void i(int j); void i(); 3927 // void i(); void i(int j) {} 3928 // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change 3929 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 3930 // type without a prototype. 3931 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() && 3932 !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3933 const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto; 3934 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 3935 WithProto = New; 3936 WithoutProto = Old; 3937 } else { 3938 WithProto = Old; 3939 WithoutProto = New; 3940 } 3941 3942 if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) { 3943 if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) { 3944 // The one without the prototype will be changing behavior in C2x, so 3945 // warn about that one so long as it's a user-visible declaration. 3946 bool IsWithoutProtoADef = false, IsWithProtoADef = false; 3947 if (WithoutProto == New) 3948 IsWithoutProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 3949 else 3950 IsWithProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 3951 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3952 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 3953 << IsWithoutProtoADef << (WithoutProto->getNumParams() ? 0 : 1) 3954 << (WithoutProto == Old) << IsWithProtoADef; 3955 3956 // The reason the one without the prototype will be changing behavior 3957 // is because of the one with the prototype, so note that so long as 3958 // it's a user-visible declaration. There is one exception to this: 3959 // when the new declaration is a definition without a prototype, the 3960 // old declaration with a prototype is not the cause of the issue, 3961 // and that does not need to be noted because the one with a 3962 // prototype will not change behavior in C2x. 3963 if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit() && 3964 !IsWithoutProtoADef) 3965 Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), diag::note_conflicting_prototype); 3966 } 3967 } 3968 } 3969 3970 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 3971 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3972 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3973 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 3974 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 3975 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 3976 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 3977 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 3978 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 3979 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 3980 NewQType = 3981 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 3982 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 3983 New->setType(NewQType); 3984 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 3985 3986 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 3987 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 3988 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 3989 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create( 3990 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 3991 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 3992 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 3993 Param->setImplicit(); 3994 Params.push_back(Param); 3995 } 3996 3997 New->setParams(Params); 3998 } 3999 4000 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4001 } 4002 } 4003 4004 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 4005 // spaces are ignored. 4006 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 4007 return false; 4008 4009 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 4010 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 4011 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 4012 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 4013 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 4014 // the prototype. 4015 // 4016 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 4017 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 4018 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 4019 // C99 6.9.1p8. 4020 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4021 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 4022 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 4023 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 4024 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 4025 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 4026 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 4027 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4028 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 4029 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4030 4031 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 4032 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 4033 NewProto->getReturnType()); 4034 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 4035 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 4036 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 4037 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 4038 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 4039 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4040 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 4041 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4042 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4043 NewParm->getType(), 4044 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 4045 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 4046 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 4047 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 4048 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4049 } else 4050 LooseCompatible = false; 4051 } 4052 4053 if (LooseCompatible) { 4054 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 4055 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 4056 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 4057 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 4058 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 4059 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 4060 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 4061 diag::note_previous_declaration); 4062 } 4063 4064 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4065 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 4066 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 4067 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4068 } 4069 4070 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 4071 } 4072 4073 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 4074 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 4075 4076 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 4077 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 4078 unsigned BuiltinID; 4079 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 4080 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 4081 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 4082 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 4083 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 4084 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 4085 << Old << Old->getType(); 4086 return false; 4087 } 4088 4089 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 4090 } 4091 4092 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 4093 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 4094 return true; 4095 } 4096 4097 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 4098 /// known to be compatible. 4099 /// 4100 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 4101 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 4102 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 4103 /// redeclaration of Old. 4104 /// 4105 /// \returns false 4106 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 4107 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4108 // Merge the attributes 4109 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4110 4111 // Merge "pure" flag. 4112 if (Old->isPure()) 4113 New->setPure(); 4114 4115 // Merge "used" flag. 4116 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4117 New->setIsUsed(); 4118 4119 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 4120 // declarations. 4121 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 4122 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 4123 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 4124 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 4125 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4126 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4127 } 4128 4129 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4130 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 4131 4132 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 4133 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 4134 // was visible. 4135 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 4136 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4137 New->setType(Merged); 4138 4139 return false; 4140 } 4141 4142 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 4143 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 4144 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 4145 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 4146 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 4147 ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation 4148 : AMK_ProtocolImplementation) 4149 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 4150 : AMK_Override; 4151 4152 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 4153 4154 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 4155 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 4156 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 4157 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 4158 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 4159 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 4160 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 4161 4162 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 4163 } 4164 4165 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 4166 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 4167 4168 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 4169 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 4170 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 4171 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 4172 4173 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4174 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4175 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 4176 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4177 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4178 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4179 } 4180 4181 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 4182 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 4183 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4184 /// 4185 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 4186 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 4187 /// is attached. 4188 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 4189 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4190 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 4191 return; 4192 4193 QualType MergedT; 4194 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4195 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 4196 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 4197 return; 4198 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 4199 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 4200 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 4201 } 4202 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 4203 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 4204 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 4205 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 4206 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 4207 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 4208 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 4209 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 4210 4211 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 4212 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 4213 // mismatch. 4214 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 4215 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 4216 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 4217 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 4218 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 4219 continue; 4220 4221 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 4222 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 4223 } 4224 } 4225 4226 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 4227 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4228 NewArray->getElementType())) 4229 MergedT = New->getType(); 4230 } 4231 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 4232 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 4233 // visible. 4234 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 4235 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4236 NewArray->getElementType())) 4237 MergedT = Old->getType(); 4238 } 4239 } 4240 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4241 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4242 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 4243 Old->getType()); 4244 } 4245 } else { 4246 // C 6.2.7p2: 4247 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 4248 // compatible type. 4249 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 4250 } 4251 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 4252 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 4253 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 4254 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 4255 // equivalent. 4256 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 4257 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 4258 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 4259 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 4260 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 4261 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 4262 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4263 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 4264 return; 4265 } 4266 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 4267 } 4268 4269 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 4270 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 4271 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4272 New->setType(MergedT); 4273 } 4274 4275 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 4276 LookupResult &Previous) { 4277 // C11 6.2.7p4: 4278 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 4279 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 4280 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 4281 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 4282 // declaration becomes the composite type. 4283 // 4284 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 4285 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 4286 return false; 4287 4288 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4289 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 4290 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 4291 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 4292 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 4293 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 4294 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4295 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 4296 } else { 4297 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4298 // type unless we're in the same function. 4299 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4300 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4301 } 4302 } 4303 4304 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4305 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4306 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4307 /// 4308 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4309 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4310 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4311 /// 4312 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4313 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4314 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4315 return; 4316 4317 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4318 return; 4319 4320 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4321 4322 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4323 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4324 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4325 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4326 if (NewTemplate) { 4327 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4328 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4329 4330 if (auto *Shadow = 4331 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4332 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4333 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4334 } else { 4335 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4336 4337 if (auto *Shadow = 4338 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4339 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4340 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4341 } 4342 } 4343 if (!Old) { 4344 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4345 << New->getDeclName(); 4346 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4347 New->getLocation()); 4348 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4349 } 4350 4351 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 4352 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 4353 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4354 4355 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4356 if (NewTemplate && 4357 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4358 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4359 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4360 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4361 4362 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4363 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4364 // 4365 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4366 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4367 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4368 << New->getIdentifier(); 4369 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4370 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4371 } 4372 4373 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4374 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4375 // declaration 4376 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4377 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4378 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4379 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4380 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4381 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4382 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4383 } 4384 4385 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 4386 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4387 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 4388 << ILA; 4389 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4390 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4391 } 4392 4393 // Merge the types. 4394 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4395 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4396 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4397 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4398 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4399 return; 4400 } 4401 4402 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4403 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4404 return; 4405 4406 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4407 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4408 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4409 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4410 4411 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4412 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4413 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4414 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4415 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4416 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4417 << New->getDeclName(); 4418 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4419 } else { 4420 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4421 << New->getDeclName(); 4422 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4423 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4424 } 4425 } 4426 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4427 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4428 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4429 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4430 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4431 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4432 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4433 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4434 // identifier has external linkage. 4435 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4436 /* Okay */; 4437 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4438 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4439 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4440 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4441 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4442 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4443 } 4444 4445 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4446 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4447 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4448 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4449 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4450 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4451 } 4452 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4453 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4454 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4455 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4456 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4457 } 4458 4459 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 4460 return; 4461 4462 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4463 4464 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4465 // need to check for mismatches. 4466 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4467 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4468 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4469 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4470 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4471 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4472 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4473 } 4474 4475 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4476 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4477 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4478 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4479 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4480 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4481 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4482 } 4483 } 4484 4485 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4486 // UndefinedButUsed. 4487 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4488 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4489 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4490 SourceLocation())); 4491 4492 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4493 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4494 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4495 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4496 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4497 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4498 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4499 } else { 4500 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4501 // static and dynamic initialization. 4502 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4503 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4504 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4505 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4506 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4507 } 4508 } 4509 4510 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4511 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4512 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4513 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4514 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4515 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4516 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4517 } else if (New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4518 VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition(); 4519 if (Def && checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4520 return; 4521 } 4522 } 4523 4524 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4525 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4526 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4527 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4528 return; 4529 } 4530 4531 // Merge "used" flag. 4532 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4533 New->setIsUsed(); 4534 4535 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4536 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4537 if (NewTemplate) 4538 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4539 4540 // Inherit access appropriately. 4541 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4542 if (NewTemplate) 4543 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4544 4545 if (Old->isInline()) 4546 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4547 } 4548 4549 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4550 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4551 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4552 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4553 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4554 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4555 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4556 StringRef HdrFilename = 4557 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4558 4559 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4560 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4561 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4562 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4563 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4564 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4565 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4566 if (Mod) { 4567 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4568 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4569 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4570 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4571 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4572 } else { 4573 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4574 << HdrFilename.str(); 4575 } 4576 return true; 4577 } 4578 4579 return false; 4580 }; 4581 4582 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4583 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4584 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4585 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4586 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4587 bool EmittedDiag = 4588 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4589 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4590 4591 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4592 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4593 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4594 4595 if (EmittedDiag) 4596 return; 4597 } 4598 4599 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4600 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4601 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4602 } 4603 4604 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4605 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4606 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4607 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4608 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4609 New->isInline() || 4610 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4611 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4612 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4613 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4614 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4615 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4616 4617 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4618 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4619 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4620 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4621 return false; 4622 } else { 4623 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4624 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4625 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4626 return true; 4627 } 4628 } 4629 4630 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4631 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4632 Decl * 4633 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4634 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4635 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, 4636 AnonRecord); 4637 } 4638 4639 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4640 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4641 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4642 // compatibility. 4643 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4644 // targeted. 4645 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4646 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4647 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4648 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4649 } 4650 4651 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4652 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4653 return; 4654 4655 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4656 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4657 // it is anonymous. 4658 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4659 return; 4660 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4661 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4662 Context.setManglingNumber( 4663 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4664 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4665 return; 4666 } 4667 4668 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4669 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4670 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4671 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4672 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4673 if (MCtx) { 4674 Context.setManglingNumber( 4675 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4676 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4677 } 4678 } 4679 4680 namespace { 4681 struct NonCLikeKind { 4682 enum { 4683 None, 4684 BaseClass, 4685 DefaultMemberInit, 4686 Lambda, 4687 Friend, 4688 OtherMember, 4689 Invalid, 4690 } Kind = None; 4691 SourceRange Range; 4692 4693 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4694 }; 4695 } 4696 4697 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4698 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4699 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4700 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4701 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4702 4703 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4704 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4705 // 4706 // -- have any base classes 4707 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4708 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4709 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4710 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4711 bool Invalid = false; 4712 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4713 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4714 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4715 Invalid = true; 4716 continue; 4717 } 4718 4719 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4720 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4721 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4722 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4723 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4724 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4725 } 4726 continue; 4727 } 4728 4729 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4730 // P1766, but not the intent. 4731 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4732 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4733 4734 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4735 // enumerations, or member classes, 4736 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4737 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4738 continue; 4739 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4740 if (!MemberRD) { 4741 if (D->isImplicit()) 4742 continue; 4743 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4744 } 4745 4746 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4747 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4748 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4749 4750 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4751 // (recursively). 4752 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4753 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4754 return Kind; 4755 } 4756 } 4757 4758 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4759 } 4760 4761 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4762 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4763 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4764 return; 4765 4766 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4767 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4768 return; 4769 4770 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4771 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4772 4773 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4774 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4775 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4776 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4777 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4778 return; 4779 } 4780 4781 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4782 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4783 // C-like]. 4784 // 4785 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4786 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4787 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4788 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4789 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4790 : NonCLikeKind(); 4791 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4792 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4793 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4794 return; 4795 4796 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4797 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4798 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4799 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4800 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4801 else 4802 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4803 } 4804 4805 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4806 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4807 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4808 TextToInsert += ' '; 4809 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4810 4811 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4812 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4813 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4814 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4815 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4816 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4817 } 4818 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4819 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4820 4821 if (ChangesLinkage) 4822 return; 4823 } 4824 4825 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4826 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4827 } 4828 4829 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4830 switch (T) { 4831 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4832 return 0; 4833 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4834 return 1; 4835 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4836 return 2; 4837 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4838 return 3; 4839 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4840 return 4; 4841 default: 4842 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4843 } 4844 } 4845 4846 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4847 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4848 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4849 Decl * 4850 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4851 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4852 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4853 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4854 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4855 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4856 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4857 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4858 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4859 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4860 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4861 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4862 4863 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4864 return nullptr; 4865 4866 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4867 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4868 // it's a Type. 4869 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4870 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4871 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4872 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4873 } 4874 4875 if (Tag) { 4876 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 4877 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 4878 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 4879 return Tag; 4880 } 4881 4882 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4883 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 4884 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 4885 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4886 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4887 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 4888 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4889 } 4890 4891 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 4892 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 4893 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 4894 4895 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 4896 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 4897 // and definitions of functions and variables. 4898 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 4899 // the declaration of a function or function template 4900 if (Tag) 4901 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 4902 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 4903 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4904 else 4905 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 4906 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4907 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 4908 return TagD; 4909 } 4910 4911 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 4912 4913 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 4914 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 4915 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 4916 if (TagD && !Tag) 4917 return nullptr; 4918 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 4919 } 4920 4921 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 4922 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 4923 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 4924 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 4925 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 4926 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 4927 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 4928 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 4929 // or an explicit specialization. 4930 // 4931 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 4932 // obvious intent of DR1819. 4933 // 4934 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 4935 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 4936 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 4937 return nullptr; 4938 } 4939 4940 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 4941 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 4942 4943 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 4944 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 4945 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 4946 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4947 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 4948 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 4949 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 4950 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 4951 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 4952 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 4953 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 4954 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 4955 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 4956 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4957 AnonRecord = Record; 4958 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 4959 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4960 } 4961 4962 DeclaresAnything = false; 4963 } 4964 } 4965 4966 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 4967 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 4968 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 4969 // 4970 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 4971 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 4972 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 4973 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 4974 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 4975 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 4976 // struct STRUCT; 4977 // union UNION; 4978 // and 4979 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 4980 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 4981 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 4982 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 4983 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 4984 if (Tag) 4985 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 4986 else if (const RecordType *RT = 4987 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 4988 Record = RT->getDecl(); 4989 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 4990 Record = UT->getDecl(); 4991 4992 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4993 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 4994 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 4995 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 4996 } 4997 4998 DeclaresAnything = false; 4999 } 5000 } 5001 5002 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 5003 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 5004 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 5005 return TagD; 5006 5007 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5008 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5009 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 5010 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 5011 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 5012 DeclaresAnything = false; 5013 5014 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 5015 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 5016 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5017 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 5018 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5019 else 5020 DeclaresAnything = false; 5021 } 5022 5023 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 5024 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5025 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 5026 << Tag->getTagKind() 5027 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5028 5029 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 5030 5031 // C 6.7/2: 5032 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 5033 // or the members of an enumeration. 5034 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5035 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5036 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5037 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 5038 // previous declaration. 5039 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 5040 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 5041 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 5042 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 5043 ? diag::err_no_declarators 5044 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 5045 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5046 return TagD; 5047 } 5048 5049 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 5050 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 5051 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5052 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 5053 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 5054 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5055 // 5056 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 5057 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 5058 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5059 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 5060 5061 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 5062 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 5063 // useless. 5064 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 5065 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 5066 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 5067 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 5068 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5069 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5070 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5071 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 5072 } 5073 5074 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 5075 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5076 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 5077 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5078 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5079 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 5080 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5081 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 5082 // Restrict is covered above. 5083 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5084 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 5085 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5086 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 5087 } 5088 5089 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 5090 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 5091 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 5092 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) { 5093 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 5094 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 5095 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 5096 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 5097 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 5098 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 5099 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 5100 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5101 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5102 } 5103 } 5104 5105 return TagD; 5106 } 5107 5108 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 5109 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 5110 /// 5111 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 5112 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 5113 Scope *S, 5114 DeclContext *Owner, 5115 DeclarationName Name, 5116 SourceLocation NameLoc, 5117 bool IsUnion) { 5118 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 5119 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 5120 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 5121 5122 // Pick a representative declaration. 5123 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5124 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 5125 5126 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 5127 return false; 5128 5129 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 5130 << IsUnion << Name; 5131 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5132 5133 return true; 5134 } 5135 5136 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 5137 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 5138 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 5139 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 5140 /// struct, e.g., 5141 /// 5142 /// @code 5143 /// union { 5144 /// int i; 5145 /// float f; 5146 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 5147 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 5148 /// @endcode 5149 /// 5150 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 5151 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 5152 static bool 5153 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 5154 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 5155 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 5156 bool Invalid = false; 5157 5158 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 5159 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 5160 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 5161 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 5162 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 5163 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 5164 VD->getLocation(), 5165 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 5166 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5167 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 5168 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 5169 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 5170 Invalid = true; 5171 } else { 5172 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5173 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 5174 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 5175 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 5176 // anonymous union is declared. 5177 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 5178 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 5179 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 5180 else 5181 Chaining.push_back(VD); 5182 5183 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 5184 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 5185 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 5186 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 5187 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 5188 5189 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 5190 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 5191 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 5192 5193 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 5194 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 5195 5196 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5197 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 5198 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 5199 5200 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 5201 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5202 5203 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 5204 } 5205 } 5206 } 5207 5208 return Invalid; 5209 } 5210 5211 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 5212 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 5213 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 5214 static StorageClass 5215 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5216 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5217 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5218 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 5219 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 5220 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 5221 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 5222 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 5223 return SC_None; 5224 return SC_Extern; 5225 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 5226 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 5227 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 5228 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 5229 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 5230 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 5231 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 5232 } 5233 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 5234 } 5235 5236 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 5237 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 5238 5239 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 5240 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 5241 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 5242 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 5243 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 5244 return FD->getLocation(); 5245 } 5246 5247 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 5248 } 5249 5250 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5251 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 5252 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5253 return; 5254 5255 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 5256 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 5257 } 5258 5259 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5260 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 5261 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5262 return; 5263 5264 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 5265 } 5266 5267 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 5268 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 5269 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 5270 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 5271 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5272 AccessSpecifier AS, 5273 RecordDecl *Record, 5274 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 5275 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 5276 5277 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 5278 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 5279 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 5280 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5281 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 5282 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 5283 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 5284 5285 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 5286 // structs/unions. 5287 bool Invalid = false; 5288 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5289 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 5290 if (Record->isUnion()) { 5291 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5292 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 5293 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 5294 // global namespace shall be declared static. 5295 unsigned DiagID; 5296 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 5297 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 5298 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 5299 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 5300 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5301 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5302 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5303 5304 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5305 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5306 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5307 } 5308 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5309 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5310 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5311 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5312 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5313 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5314 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5315 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5316 5317 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5318 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5319 SourceLocation(), 5320 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5321 } 5322 } 5323 5324 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5325 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5326 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5327 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5328 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5329 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5330 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5331 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5332 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5333 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5334 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5335 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5336 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5337 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5338 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5339 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5340 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5341 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5342 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5343 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5344 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5345 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5346 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5347 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5348 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5349 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5350 5351 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5352 } 5353 5354 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5355 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5356 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5357 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5358 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5359 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5360 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5361 continue; 5362 5363 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5364 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5365 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5366 // members (clause 11). 5367 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5368 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5369 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5370 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5371 Invalid = true; 5372 } 5373 5374 // C++ [class.union]p1 5375 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5376 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5377 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5378 // array of such objects. 5379 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5380 Invalid = true; 5381 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5382 // Any implicit members are fine. 5383 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5384 // This is a type that showed up in an 5385 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5386 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5387 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5388 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5389 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5390 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5391 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5392 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5393 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5394 << Record->isUnion(); 5395 else { 5396 // This is a nested type declaration. 5397 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5398 << Record->isUnion(); 5399 Invalid = true; 5400 } 5401 } else { 5402 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5403 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5404 // not part of standard C++. 5405 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5406 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5407 << Record->isUnion(); 5408 } 5409 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5410 // Any access specifier is fine. 5411 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5412 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5413 } else { 5414 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5415 // member. Complain about it. 5416 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5417 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5418 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5419 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5420 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5421 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5422 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5423 5424 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5425 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5426 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5427 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5428 << Record->isUnion(); 5429 else { 5430 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5431 Invalid = true; 5432 } 5433 } 5434 } 5435 5436 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5437 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5438 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5439 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5440 Owner->isRecord()) 5441 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5442 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5443 } 5444 5445 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5446 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5447 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5448 Invalid = true; 5449 } 5450 5451 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5452 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5453 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5454 // names into the program 5455 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5456 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5457 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5458 // 5459 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5460 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5461 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5462 5463 // Mock up a declarator. 5464 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Member); 5465 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5466 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5467 5468 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5469 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5470 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5471 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5472 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5473 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5474 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5475 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5476 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5477 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5478 5479 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5480 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5481 } else { 5482 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5483 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5484 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5485 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5486 // an error here 5487 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5488 Invalid = true; 5489 SC = SC_None; 5490 } 5491 5492 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5493 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5494 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5495 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5496 5497 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5498 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5499 // initializer: 5500 // union { int n = 0; }; 5501 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5502 } 5503 Anon->setImplicit(); 5504 5505 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5506 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5507 5508 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5509 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5510 // its members. 5511 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5512 5513 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5514 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5515 // purposes. 5516 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5517 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5518 5519 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5520 Invalid = true; 5521 5522 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5523 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5524 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5525 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5526 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5527 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5528 if (MCtx) { 5529 Context.setManglingNumber( 5530 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5531 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5532 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5533 } 5534 } 5535 } 5536 5537 if (Invalid) 5538 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5539 5540 return Anon; 5541 } 5542 5543 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5544 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5545 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5546 /// Example: 5547 /// 5548 /// struct A { int a; }; 5549 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5550 /// 5551 /// void foo() { 5552 /// B var; 5553 /// var.a = 3; 5554 /// } 5555 /// 5556 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5557 RecordDecl *Record) { 5558 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5559 5560 // Mock up a declarator. 5561 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::TypeName); 5562 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5563 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5564 5565 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5566 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5567 5568 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5569 NamedDecl *Anon = 5570 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5571 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5572 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5573 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5574 Anon->setImplicit(); 5575 5576 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5577 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5578 5579 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5580 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5581 // purposes. 5582 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5583 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5584 5585 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5586 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5587 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5588 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5589 AS_none, Chain)) { 5590 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5591 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5592 } 5593 5594 return Anon; 5595 } 5596 5597 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5598 /// given Declarator. 5599 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5600 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5601 } 5602 5603 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5604 DeclarationNameInfo 5605 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5606 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5607 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5608 5609 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5610 5611 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5612 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5613 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5614 return NameInfo; 5615 5616 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5617 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5618 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5619 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5620 // of the simple-template-id. 5621 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5622 // class template. 5623 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5624 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5625 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5626 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5627 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5628 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5629 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5630 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5631 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5632 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5633 if (Template) 5634 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5635 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5636 } 5637 5638 NameInfo.setName( 5639 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5640 return NameInfo; 5641 } 5642 5643 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5644 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5645 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5646 NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange( 5647 Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation)); 5648 return NameInfo; 5649 5650 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5651 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5652 Name.Identifier)); 5653 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5654 return NameInfo; 5655 5656 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5657 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5658 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5659 if (Ty.isNull()) 5660 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5661 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5662 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5663 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5664 return NameInfo; 5665 } 5666 5667 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5668 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5669 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5670 if (Ty.isNull()) 5671 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5672 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5673 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5674 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5675 return NameInfo; 5676 } 5677 5678 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5679 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5680 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5681 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5682 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5683 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5684 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5685 5686 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5687 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5688 5689 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5690 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5691 // was qualified. 5692 5693 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5694 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5695 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5696 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5697 return NameInfo; 5698 } 5699 5700 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5701 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5702 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5703 if (Ty.isNull()) 5704 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5705 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5706 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5707 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5708 return NameInfo; 5709 } 5710 5711 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5712 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5713 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5714 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5715 } 5716 5717 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5718 5719 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5720 } 5721 5722 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5723 do { 5724 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5725 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5726 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5727 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5728 else 5729 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5730 } while (true); 5731 } 5732 5733 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5734 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5735 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5736 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5737 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5738 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5739 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5740 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5741 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5742 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5743 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5744 Params.clear(); 5745 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5746 return false; 5747 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5748 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5749 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5750 5751 // The parameter types are identical 5752 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5753 continue; 5754 5755 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5756 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5757 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5758 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5759 5760 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5761 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5762 Params.push_back(Idx); 5763 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5764 return false; 5765 } 5766 5767 return true; 5768 } 5769 5770 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5771 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5772 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5773 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5774 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5775 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5776 DeclarationName Name) { 5777 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5778 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5779 // - types which will become injected class names 5780 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5781 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5782 // few cases here. 5783 5784 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5785 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5786 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5787 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5788 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5789 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5790 // Grab the type from the parser. 5791 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5792 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5793 if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break; 5794 5795 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5796 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5797 // attached already. 5798 if (!TSI) 5799 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5800 5801 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5802 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5803 if (!TSI) return true; 5804 5805 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5806 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5807 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5808 break; 5809 } 5810 5811 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5812 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5813 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5814 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5815 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5816 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5817 break; 5818 } 5819 5820 default: 5821 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5822 break; 5823 } 5824 5825 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5826 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5827 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5828 5829 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5830 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5831 // pointer. 5832 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5833 continue; 5834 5835 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5836 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5837 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5838 return true; 5839 } 5840 5841 return false; 5842 } 5843 5844 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a 5845 /// system macro. 5846 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) { 5847 return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) || 5848 SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation()); 5849 } 5850 5851 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) { 5852 // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration 5853 // of system decl. 5854 if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit()) 5855 return; 5856 ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts()); 5857 if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved && 5858 !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) { 5859 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol) 5860 << D << static_cast<int>(Status); 5861 } 5862 } 5863 5864 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5865 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration); 5866 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 5867 5868 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 5869 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 5870 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 5871 5872 return Dcl; 5873 } 5874 5875 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 5876 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 5877 /// name different from T: 5878 /// - every static data member of class T; 5879 /// - every member function of class T 5880 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 5881 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 5882 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 5883 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 5884 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5885 5886 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 5887 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 5888 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 5889 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 5890 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 5891 return true; 5892 } 5893 5894 return false; 5895 } 5896 5897 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 5898 /// nested-name-specifier. 5899 /// 5900 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5901 /// 5902 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 5903 /// resolves. 5904 /// 5905 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 5906 /// 5907 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 5908 /// 5909 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 5910 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 5911 /// 5912 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 5913 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 5914 DeclarationName Name, 5915 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 5916 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 5917 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 5918 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 5919 5920 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 5921 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 5922 // 5923 // class X { 5924 // void X::f(); 5925 // }; 5926 // 5927 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 5928 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 5929 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 5930 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5931 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 5932 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 5933 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 5934 SS.clear(); 5935 } else { 5936 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 5937 } 5938 return false; 5939 } 5940 5941 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 5942 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 5943 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 5944 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 5945 if (Cur->isRecord()) 5946 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5947 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5948 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 5949 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 5950 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5951 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 5952 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 5953 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5954 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 5955 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 5956 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5957 else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) { 5958 if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC)) 5959 Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name) 5960 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5961 else 5962 // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in 5963 // CheckRedeclarationExported. 5964 return false; 5965 } else 5966 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 5967 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 5968 5969 return true; 5970 } 5971 5972 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5973 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 5974 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5975 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5976 SS.clear(); 5977 5978 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 5979 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 5980 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 5981 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 5982 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 5983 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 5984 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 5985 return true; 5986 5987 return false; 5988 } 5989 5990 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 5991 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 5992 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 5993 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 5994 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 5995 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 5996 if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>( 5997 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 5998 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 5999 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 6000 6001 return false; 6002 } 6003 6004 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 6005 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 6006 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 6007 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 6008 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6009 6010 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 6011 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 6012 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6013 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 6014 } else if (!Name) { 6015 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 6016 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 6017 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 6018 return nullptr; 6019 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6020 return nullptr; 6021 6022 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 6023 // we find one that is. 6024 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 6025 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 6026 S = S->getParent(); 6027 6028 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 6029 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 6030 D.setInvalidType(); 6031 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6032 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6033 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 6034 return nullptr; 6035 6036 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 6037 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 6038 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 6039 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 6040 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 6041 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 6042 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 6043 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6044 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 6045 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 6046 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6047 return nullptr; 6048 } 6049 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 6050 6051 if (!IsDependentContext && 6052 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 6053 return nullptr; 6054 6055 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 6056 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 6057 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6058 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 6059 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6060 return nullptr; 6061 } 6062 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 6063 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 6064 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6065 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 6066 if (DC->isRecord()) 6067 return nullptr; 6068 6069 D.setInvalidType(); 6070 } 6071 } 6072 6073 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 6074 // declaration in the current instantiation. 6075 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 6076 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 6077 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 6078 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 6079 D.setInvalidType(); 6080 } 6081 } 6082 6083 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 6084 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6085 6086 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 6087 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6088 D.setInvalidType(); 6089 6090 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 6091 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 6092 6093 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 6094 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6095 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 6096 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 6097 6098 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 6099 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 6100 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 6101 // 6102 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 6103 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 6104 // the same name. 6105 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 6106 /* Do nothing*/; 6107 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 6108 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 6109 R->isFunctionType())) { 6110 IsLinkageLookup = true; 6111 CreateBuiltins = 6112 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 6113 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 6114 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 6115 CreateBuiltins = true; 6116 6117 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 6118 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 6119 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 6120 } 6121 6122 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 6123 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 6124 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 6125 6126 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6127 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 6128 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 6129 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 6130 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 6131 // thereof; [...] 6132 // 6133 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 6134 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 6135 // we want to match. For example, given: 6136 // 6137 // class X { 6138 // void f(); 6139 // void f(float); 6140 // }; 6141 // 6142 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 6143 // 6144 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 6145 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 6146 // matches. 6147 6148 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6149 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 6150 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 6151 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 6152 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 6153 } 6154 6155 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 6156 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 6157 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 6158 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 6159 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6160 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 6161 6162 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 6163 Previous.clear(); 6164 } 6165 6166 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 6167 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 6168 Previous.clear(); 6169 6170 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 6171 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 6172 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 6173 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 6174 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 6175 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 6176 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 6177 Previous.clear(); 6178 6179 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 6180 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 6181 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6182 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6183 6184 NamedDecl *New; 6185 6186 bool AddToScope = true; 6187 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 6188 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 6189 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 6190 return nullptr; 6191 } 6192 6193 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 6194 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 6195 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 6196 TemplateParamLists, 6197 AddToScope); 6198 } else { 6199 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 6200 AddToScope); 6201 } 6202 6203 if (!New) 6204 return nullptr; 6205 6206 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 6207 // add it to the scope stack. 6208 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 6209 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 6210 6211 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 6212 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 6213 6214 return New; 6215 } 6216 6217 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6218 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6219 /// GCC compatibility). 6220 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 6221 ASTContext &Context, 6222 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6223 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6224 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 6225 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 6226 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 6227 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 6228 SizeIsNegative = false; 6229 Oversized = 0; 6230 6231 if (T->isDependentType()) 6232 return QualType(); 6233 6234 QualifierCollector Qs; 6235 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 6236 6237 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 6238 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6239 QualType FixedType = 6240 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6241 Oversized); 6242 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6243 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 6244 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6245 } 6246 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 6247 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 6248 QualType FixedType = 6249 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6250 Oversized); 6251 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6252 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 6253 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6254 } 6255 6256 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 6257 if (!VLATy) 6258 return QualType(); 6259 6260 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 6261 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6262 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 6263 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6264 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 6265 return QualType(); 6266 } 6267 6268 Expr::EvalResult Result; 6269 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 6270 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 6271 return QualType(); 6272 6273 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 6274 6275 // Check whether the array size is negative. 6276 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 6277 SizeIsNegative = true; 6278 return QualType(); 6279 } 6280 6281 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 6282 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 6283 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 6284 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 6285 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 6286 : Res.getActiveBits(); 6287 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 6288 Oversized = Res; 6289 return QualType(); 6290 } 6291 6292 QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType( 6293 ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6294 return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType); 6295 } 6296 6297 static void 6298 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 6299 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6300 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6301 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 6302 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 6303 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 6304 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 6305 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 6306 return; 6307 } 6308 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 6309 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 6310 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 6311 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 6312 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 6313 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 6314 return; 6315 } 6316 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6317 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6318 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 6319 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 6320 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 6321 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 6322 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 6323 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 6324 } else { 6325 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6326 } 6327 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6328 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6329 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6330 } 6331 6332 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6333 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6334 /// GCC compatibility). 6335 static TypeSourceInfo* 6336 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6337 ASTContext &Context, 6338 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6339 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6340 QualType FixedTy 6341 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6342 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6343 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6344 return nullptr; 6345 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6346 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6347 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6348 return FixedTInfo; 6349 } 6350 6351 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning 6352 /// true if we were successful. 6353 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, 6354 QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, 6355 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) { 6356 bool SizeIsNegative; 6357 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6358 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 6359 TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6360 if (FixedTInfo) { 6361 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6362 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 6363 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 6364 return true; 6365 } 6366 6367 if (SizeIsNegative) 6368 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6369 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6370 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10); 6371 else if (FailedFoldDiagID) 6372 Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID); 6373 return false; 6374 } 6375 6376 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6377 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6378 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6379 /// function-scope declarations. 6380 void 6381 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6382 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6383 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6384 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6385 return; 6386 6387 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6388 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6389 } 6390 6391 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6392 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6393 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6394 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6395 } 6396 6397 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6398 /// does not identify a function. 6399 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6400 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6401 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6402 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6403 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6404 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6405 6406 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6407 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6408 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6409 6410 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6411 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6412 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6413 } 6414 6415 NamedDecl* 6416 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6417 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6418 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6419 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6420 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6421 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6422 D.setInvalidType(); 6423 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6424 DC = CurContext; 6425 Previous.clear(); 6426 } 6427 6428 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6429 6430 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6431 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6432 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6433 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6434 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6435 << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 6436 6437 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6438 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6439 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6440 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6441 << "typedef"; 6442 else 6443 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6444 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6445 return nullptr; 6446 } 6447 6448 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6449 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6450 6451 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6452 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6453 6454 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6455 6456 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6457 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6458 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6459 return ND; 6460 } 6461 6462 void 6463 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6464 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6465 // then it shall have block scope. 6466 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6467 // that redeclarations will match. 6468 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6469 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6470 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6471 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6472 6473 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6474 bool SizeIsNegative; 6475 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6476 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6477 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6478 SizeIsNegative, 6479 Oversized); 6480 if (FixedTInfo) { 6481 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6482 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6483 } else { 6484 if (SizeIsNegative) 6485 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6486 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6487 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6488 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6489 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6490 << toString(Oversized, 10); 6491 else 6492 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6493 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6494 } 6495 } 6496 } 6497 } 6498 6499 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6500 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6501 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6502 NamedDecl* 6503 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6504 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6505 6506 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6507 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6508 6509 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6510 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6511 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6512 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6513 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6514 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6515 Redeclaration = true; 6516 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6517 } else { 6518 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6519 } 6520 6521 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6522 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6523 6524 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6525 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6526 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6527 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6528 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6529 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6530 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6531 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6532 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6533 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6534 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6535 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6536 } 6537 6538 return NewTD; 6539 } 6540 6541 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6542 /// previous declaration. 6543 /// 6544 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6545 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6546 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6547 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6548 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6549 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6550 /// 6551 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6552 /// lookup 6553 /// 6554 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6555 /// declared. 6556 /// 6557 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6558 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6559 static bool 6560 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6561 ASTContext &Context) { 6562 if (!PrevDecl) 6563 return false; 6564 6565 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6566 return false; 6567 6568 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6569 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6570 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6571 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6572 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6573 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6574 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6575 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6576 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6577 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6578 return false; 6579 6580 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6581 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6582 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6583 return false; 6584 6585 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6586 // previous declarations. 6587 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6588 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6589 6590 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6591 // isn't the same function. 6592 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6593 return false; 6594 } 6595 6596 return true; 6597 } 6598 6599 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6600 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6601 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6602 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6603 } 6604 6605 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6606 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6607 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6608 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6609 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6610 unsigned kind = -1U; 6611 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6612 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6613 kind = 0; // __block 6614 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6615 kind = 1; // global 6616 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6617 kind = 3; // ivar 6618 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6619 kind = 2; // field 6620 } 6621 6622 if (kind != -1U) { 6623 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6624 << kind; 6625 } 6626 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6627 // Try to infer lifetime. 6628 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6629 return false; 6630 6631 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6632 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6633 decl->setType(type); 6634 } 6635 6636 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6637 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6638 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6639 var->getTLSKind()) { 6640 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6641 << var->getType(); 6642 return true; 6643 } 6644 } 6645 6646 return false; 6647 } 6648 6649 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6650 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6651 return; 6652 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6653 return; 6654 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6655 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6656 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6657 return; 6658 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6659 // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the 6660 // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space 6661 // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside 6662 // a function are inferred to be __global. 6663 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) && 6664 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6665 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6666 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6667 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6668 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6669 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6670 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6671 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6672 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6673 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6674 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6675 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6676 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6677 } 6678 } 6679 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6680 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6681 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6682 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6683 // qualified, not the array type." 6684 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6685 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6686 Decl->setType(Type); 6687 } 6688 } 6689 6690 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6691 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6692 // the wrong linkage. 6693 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6694 6695 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6696 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6697 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6698 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6699 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6700 } 6701 } 6702 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6703 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6704 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6705 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6706 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6707 } 6708 } 6709 6710 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6711 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6712 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6713 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6714 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6715 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6716 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6717 } 6718 } 6719 } 6720 6721 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6722 // It does not apply to functions. 6723 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6724 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6725 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6726 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6727 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6728 } 6729 } 6730 6731 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6732 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6733 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6734 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6735 if (VD) { 6736 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6737 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6738 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6739 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6740 } 6741 } 6742 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6743 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6744 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6745 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6746 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6747 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6748 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6749 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6750 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6751 << &ND << Attr; 6752 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6753 } 6754 } 6755 6756 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6757 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6758 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6759 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6760 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6761 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6762 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6763 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6764 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6765 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6766 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6767 // by applying it to the function type. 6768 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6769 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6770 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6771 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6772 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6773 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6774 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6775 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6776 } 6777 } 6778 } 6779 } 6780 } 6781 6782 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6783 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6784 bool IsSpecialization, 6785 bool IsDefinition) { 6786 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6787 return; 6788 6789 bool IsTemplate = false; 6790 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6791 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6792 IsTemplate = true; 6793 if (!IsSpecialization) 6794 IsDefinition = false; 6795 } 6796 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6797 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6798 IsTemplate = true; 6799 } 6800 6801 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6802 return; 6803 6804 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6805 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6806 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6807 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6808 6809 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6810 // inherited attribute instances. 6811 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6812 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6813 6814 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6815 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6816 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6817 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6818 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6819 6820 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6821 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6822 bool JustWarn = false; 6823 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6824 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6825 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6826 JustWarn = true; 6827 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6828 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6829 JustWarn = true; 6830 } 6831 6832 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6833 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6834 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6835 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6836 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6837 JustWarn = false; 6838 6839 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6840 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6841 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6842 << NewDecl 6843 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6844 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6845 if (!JustWarn) { 6846 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6847 return; 6848 } 6849 } 6850 6851 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6852 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6853 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6854 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6855 // it were marked dllexport. 6856 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6857 bool IsMicrosoftABI = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols(); 6858 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6859 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 6860 // separately. 6861 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 6862 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 6863 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 6864 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6865 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 6866 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 6867 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 6868 } 6869 6870 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 6871 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 6872 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 6873 if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) { 6874 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6875 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 6876 << NewDecl; 6877 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6878 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6879 NewDecl->addAttr( 6880 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 6881 } else { 6882 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6883 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 6884 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6885 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6886 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 6887 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6888 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6889 } 6890 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) { 6891 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 6892 // attribute. 6893 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6894 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6895 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6896 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 6897 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6898 } 6899 6900 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 6901 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 6902 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 6903 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 6904 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6905 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 6906 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 6907 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 6908 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 6909 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 6910 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 6911 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 6912 } 6913 } 6914 } 6915 } 6916 6917 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 6918 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 6919 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 6920 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 6921 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 6922 6923 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 6924 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 6925 6926 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 6927 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 6928 return false; 6929 6930 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 6931 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 6932 } 6933 6934 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 6935 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 6936 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 6937 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 6938 /// 6939 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 6940 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 6941 /// 6942 /// For instance: 6943 /// 6944 /// auto x = []{}; 6945 /// 6946 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 6947 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 6948 /// 6949 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 6950 template<typename T> 6951 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 6952 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6953 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 6954 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 6955 return false; 6956 6957 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 6958 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 6959 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 6960 return false; 6961 } 6962 return D->isExternC(); 6963 } 6964 6965 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 6966 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6967 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 6968 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6969 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 6970 if (DC->isFileContext()) 6971 return true; 6972 if (DC->isRecord()) 6973 return false; 6974 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 6975 return false; 6976 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6977 } 6978 6979 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 6980 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6981 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 6982 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6983 return true; 6984 if (DC->isRecord()) 6985 return false; 6986 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6987 } 6988 6989 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 6990 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 6991 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 6992 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6993 return true; 6994 6995 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 6996 // position to the decl itself. 6997 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 6998 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6999 return true; 7000 } 7001 7002 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 7003 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind) || 7004 PD.getDeclarationAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 7005 } 7006 7007 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 7008 /// function-local external declaration. 7009 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 7010 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 7011 return false; 7012 7013 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 7014 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 7015 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 7016 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 7017 return true; 7018 7019 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 7020 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 7021 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 7022 // innermost enclosing namespace. 7023 // 7024 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 7025 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 7026 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 7027 DC = DC->getParent(); 7028 return true; 7029 } 7030 7031 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 7032 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 7033 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 7034 return FD->isExternC(); 7035 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 7036 return VD->isExternC(); 7037 7038 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 7039 } 7040 7041 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 7042 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) { 7043 DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext(); 7044 QualType R = NewVD->getType(); 7045 7046 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 7047 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 7048 // argument. 7049 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 7050 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7051 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 7052 << R; 7053 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7054 return false; 7055 } 7056 7057 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7058 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 7059 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 7060 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 7061 // scope. 7062 if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7063 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 7064 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7065 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 7066 << R; 7067 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7068 return false; 7069 } 7070 } 7071 7072 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 7073 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", 7074 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7075 QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType(); 7076 while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7077 NR->isReferenceType()) { 7078 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7079 NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) { 7080 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) 7081 << NR->isReferenceType(); 7082 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7083 return false; 7084 } 7085 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 7086 } 7087 } 7088 7089 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", 7090 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7091 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 7092 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 7093 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 7094 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 7095 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7096 return false; 7097 } 7098 } 7099 7100 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7101 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 7102 // address space qualifiers. 7103 if (R->isEventT()) { 7104 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 7105 Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 7106 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7107 return false; 7108 } 7109 } 7110 7111 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 7112 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 7113 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 7114 // space qualifiers. 7115 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 7116 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 7117 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 7118 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7119 } 7120 7121 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 7122 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 7123 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 7124 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 7125 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7126 R.isConstQualified())) { 7127 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 7128 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7129 } 7130 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7131 return false; 7132 } 7133 7134 return true; 7135 } 7136 7137 template <typename AttrTy> 7138 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) { 7139 const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl(); 7140 if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) { 7141 AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context); 7142 Clone->setInherited(true); 7143 D->addAttr(Clone); 7144 } 7145 } 7146 7147 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 7148 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 7149 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 7150 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 7151 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 7152 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 7153 7154 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 7155 7156 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7157 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 7158 // purposes. 7159 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 7160 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 7161 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 7162 Name = II; 7163 } 7164 } else if (!II) { 7165 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 7166 return nullptr; 7167 } 7168 7169 7170 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 7171 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 7172 7173 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 7174 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 7175 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 7176 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 7177 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 7178 SC = SC_Extern; 7179 7180 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 7181 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 7182 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 7183 7184 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 7185 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 7186 // an error here 7187 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 7188 D.setInvalidType(); 7189 SC = SC_None; 7190 } 7191 7192 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 7193 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 7194 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 7195 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 7196 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 7197 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 7198 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7199 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 7200 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 7201 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7202 } 7203 7204 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 7205 7206 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 7207 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 7208 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 7209 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 7210 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 7211 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 7212 D.setInvalidType(); 7213 } 7214 } 7215 7216 // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to 7217 // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid. 7218 if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType()) 7219 tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7220 /*DiagID=*/0); 7221 7222 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 7223 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 7224 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 7225 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 7226 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 7227 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 7228 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 7229 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7230 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7231 II, R, TInfo, SC); 7232 7233 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7234 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7235 7236 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7237 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7238 7239 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 7240 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7241 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 7242 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 7243 } else { 7244 bool Invalid = false; 7245 7246 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7247 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 7248 switch (SC) { 7249 case SC_None: 7250 break; 7251 case SC_Static: 7252 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7253 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7254 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7255 break; 7256 case SC_Auto: 7257 case SC_Register: 7258 case SC_Extern: 7259 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 7260 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 7261 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 7262 // of class members 7263 7264 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7265 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 7266 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7267 break; 7268 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7269 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 7270 } 7271 } 7272 7273 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 7274 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 7275 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 7276 // incompatible with static data members. 7277 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 7278 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 7279 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 7280 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7281 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 7282 break; 7283 } 7284 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 7285 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 7286 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 7287 break; 7288 } 7289 } 7290 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 7291 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 7292 // members. 7293 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7294 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 7295 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 7296 } else if (AnonStruct) { 7297 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 7298 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 7299 // static data members. 7300 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7301 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 7302 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 7303 Invalid = true; 7304 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 7305 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 7306 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 7307 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7308 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 7309 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 7310 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 7311 } 7312 } 7313 } 7314 7315 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7316 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7317 bool InvalidScope = false; 7318 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7319 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7320 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7321 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 7322 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7323 : nullptr, 7324 TemplateParamLists, 7325 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 7326 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 7327 7328 if (TemplateParams) { 7329 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 7330 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7331 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 7332 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 7333 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7334 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 7335 << II 7336 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7337 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 7338 TemplateParams = nullptr; 7339 } else { 7340 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7341 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7342 return nullptr; 7343 7344 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7345 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 7346 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 7347 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 7348 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 7349 // This is a template declaration. 7350 IsVariableTemplate = true; 7351 7352 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 7353 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7354 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 7355 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7356 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7357 } 7358 } 7359 } else { 7360 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7361 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7362 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7363 return nullptr; 7364 assert((Invalid || 7365 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7366 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7367 } 7368 7369 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7370 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7371 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7372 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7373 : SourceLocation(); 7374 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7375 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7376 IsPartialSpecialization); 7377 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7378 return nullptr; 7379 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7380 AddToScope = false; 7381 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7382 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7383 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7384 Bindings); 7385 } else 7386 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7387 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7388 7389 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7390 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7391 NewTemplate = 7392 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7393 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7394 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7395 } 7396 7397 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7398 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7399 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7400 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7401 7402 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7403 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7404 if (NewTemplate) 7405 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7406 } 7407 7408 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7409 7410 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7411 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7412 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7413 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7414 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7415 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7416 } 7417 7418 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7419 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7420 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7421 << 0; 7422 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7423 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7424 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7425 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7426 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7427 } else { 7428 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7429 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7430 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7431 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7432 } 7433 } 7434 7435 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7436 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7437 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7438 if (NewTemplate) 7439 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7440 7441 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7442 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7443 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7444 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7445 else 7446 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7447 } 7448 7449 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7450 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7451 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7452 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7453 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7454 // explicitly. 7455 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7456 // 'extern'. 7457 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7458 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7459 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7460 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7461 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7462 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7463 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7464 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7465 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7466 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7467 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7468 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7469 // error should be ignored. 7470 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7471 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7472 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7473 // to emit any code for it. 7474 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7475 } else 7476 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7477 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7478 } else 7479 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7480 } 7481 7482 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7483 case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified: 7484 break; 7485 7486 case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval: 7487 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7488 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7489 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 7490 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7491 7492 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr: 7493 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7494 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7495 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7496 // implicitly an inline variable. 7497 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7498 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7499 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7500 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7501 break; 7502 7503 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit: 7504 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7505 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7506 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7507 else 7508 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7509 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7510 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7511 break; 7512 } 7513 7514 // C99 6.7.4p3 7515 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7516 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7517 // thread storage duration... 7518 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7519 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7520 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7521 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7522 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7523 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7524 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7525 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7526 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7527 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7528 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7529 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7530 } 7531 } 7532 7533 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7534 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7535 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7536 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7537 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7538 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7539 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7540 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7541 << 2 7542 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7543 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7544 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7545 << 0 << NewVD 7546 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7547 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7548 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7549 else { 7550 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7551 if (NewTemplate) 7552 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7553 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7554 B->setModulePrivate(); 7555 } 7556 } 7557 7558 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7559 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7560 7561 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 7562 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 7563 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7564 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 7565 << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString() 7566 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 7567 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7568 } 7569 } 7570 7571 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7572 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7573 7574 // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should 7575 // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function 7576 // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally 7577 // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen. 7578 if (R->isFunctionPointerType()) 7579 if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>()) 7580 copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT); 7581 7582 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7583 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7584 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7585 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7586 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7587 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7588 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7589 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7590 7591 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7592 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7593 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7594 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7595 // storage [duration]." 7596 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7597 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7598 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7599 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7600 } 7601 } 7602 7603 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7604 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7605 // check the VarDecl itself. 7606 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7607 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7608 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7609 7610 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7611 // retainable type. 7612 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7613 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7614 7615 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7616 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7617 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7618 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7619 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7620 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7621 switch (SC) { 7622 case SC_None: 7623 case SC_Auto: 7624 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7625 break; 7626 case SC_Register: 7627 // Local Named register 7628 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7629 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7630 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7631 break; 7632 case SC_Static: 7633 case SC_Extern: 7634 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7635 break; 7636 } 7637 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7638 // Global Named register 7639 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7640 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7641 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7642 7643 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7644 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7645 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7646 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7647 HasSizeMismatch)) 7648 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7649 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7650 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7651 } 7652 7653 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7654 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7655 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7656 } 7657 } 7658 7659 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7660 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7661 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7662 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7663 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7664 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7665 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7666 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7667 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7668 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7669 } else 7670 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7671 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7672 } 7673 } 7674 7675 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7676 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7677 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7678 : nullptr; 7679 7680 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7681 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7682 // declaration has linkage). 7683 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7684 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7685 IsMemberSpecialization || 7686 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7687 7688 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7689 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7690 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7691 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7692 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7693 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7694 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7695 7696 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7697 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7698 } else { 7699 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7700 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7701 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7702 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7703 7704 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7705 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7706 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7707 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7708 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7709 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7710 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7711 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7712 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7713 Previous.clear(); 7714 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7715 } 7716 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7717 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7718 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7719 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7720 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7721 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7722 } 7723 7724 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7725 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7726 7727 if (NewTemplate) { 7728 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7729 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7730 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7731 : nullptr; 7732 7733 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7734 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7735 // template declaration. 7736 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7737 TemplateParams, 7738 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7739 : nullptr, 7740 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7741 DC->isDependentContext()) 7742 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7743 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7744 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7745 7746 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7747 // template, make a note of that. 7748 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7749 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7750 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7751 } 7752 } 7753 7754 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7755 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7756 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7757 7758 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7759 7760 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7761 // the map of such variables. 7762 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7763 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7764 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7765 7766 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7767 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7768 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7769 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7770 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7771 if (MCtx) { 7772 Context.setManglingNumber( 7773 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7774 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7775 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7776 } 7777 } 7778 7779 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7780 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7781 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7782 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7783 7784 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7785 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7786 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7787 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7788 7789 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7790 // behavior. 7791 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7792 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7793 } 7794 7795 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7796 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7797 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7798 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7799 } 7800 7801 if (NewTemplate) { 7802 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7803 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7804 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7805 return NewTemplate; 7806 } 7807 7808 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7809 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7810 7811 return NewVD; 7812 } 7813 7814 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7815 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7816 SDK_Local, 7817 SDK_Global, 7818 SDK_StaticMember, 7819 SDK_Field, 7820 SDK_Typedef, 7821 SDK_Using, 7822 SDK_StructuredBinding 7823 }; 7824 7825 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7826 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7827 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7828 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7829 return SDK_Using; 7830 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7831 return SDK_Typedef; 7832 else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7833 return SDK_StructuredBinding; 7834 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7835 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7836 7837 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7838 } 7839 7840 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7841 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7842 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7843 const VarDecl *VD) { 7844 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7845 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7846 return Capture.getLocation(); 7847 } 7848 return SourceLocation(); 7849 } 7850 7851 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7852 const LookupResult &R) { 7853 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7854 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7855 return false; 7856 7857 // Return false if warning is ignored. 7858 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 7859 } 7860 7861 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7862 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7863 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 7864 const LookupResult &R) { 7865 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7866 return nullptr; 7867 7868 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 7869 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 7870 return nullptr; 7871 7872 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7873 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7874 : nullptr; 7875 } 7876 7877 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 7878 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7879 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 7880 const LookupResult &R) { 7881 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 7882 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 7883 return nullptr; 7884 7885 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7886 return nullptr; 7887 7888 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7889 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 7890 } 7891 7892 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7893 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7894 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D, 7895 const LookupResult &R) { 7896 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7897 return nullptr; 7898 7899 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7900 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7901 : nullptr; 7902 } 7903 7904 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 7905 /// -Wshadow. 7906 /// 7907 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 7908 /// scope. 7909 /// 7910 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 7911 /// \param R the lookup of the name 7912 /// 7913 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7914 const LookupResult &R) { 7915 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 7916 7917 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 7918 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 7919 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 7920 if (MD->isStatic()) 7921 return; 7922 7923 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 7924 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 7925 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 7926 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 7927 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 7928 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 7929 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 7930 return; 7931 } 7932 } 7933 7934 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7935 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 7936 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 7937 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 7938 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 7939 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 7940 ShadowedDecl = I; 7941 break; 7942 } 7943 } 7944 7945 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7946 7947 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 7948 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 7949 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 7950 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 7951 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 7952 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 7953 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 7954 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 7955 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 7956 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 7957 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 7958 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7959 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 7960 } else { 7961 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 7962 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 7963 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 7964 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 7965 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 7966 return; 7967 } 7968 } 7969 7970 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 7971 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 7972 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 7973 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 7974 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 7975 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 7976 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 7977 // can capture; other scopes don't. 7978 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 7979 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 7980 return; 7981 } 7982 } 7983 } 7984 } 7985 } 7986 7987 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 7988 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 7989 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 7990 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 7991 return; 7992 7993 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 7994 // static data members from base classes? 7995 7996 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 7997 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 7998 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 7999 } 8000 8001 8002 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 8003 8004 // Emit warning and note. 8005 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 8006 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 8007 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8008 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8009 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 8010 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8011 } 8012 8013 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 8014 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 8015 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 8016 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 8017 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 8018 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 8019 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 8020 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8021 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 8022 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 8023 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 8024 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 8025 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 8026 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8027 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8028 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 8029 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8030 } 8031 } 8032 8033 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 8034 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 8035 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 8036 return; 8037 8038 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 8039 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8040 LookupName(R, S); 8041 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 8042 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 8043 } 8044 8045 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 8046 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 8047 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 8048 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 8049 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 8050 return; 8051 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8052 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8053 if (!DRE) 8054 return; 8055 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 8056 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 8057 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 8058 return; 8059 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 8060 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8061 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 8062 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 8063 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8064 8065 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 8066 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 8067 } 8068 8069 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 8070 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 8071 template<typename T> 8072 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 8073 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 8074 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 8075 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 8076 8077 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8078 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 8079 // declaration. 8080 return false; 8081 } 8082 8083 if (Prev) { 8084 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8085 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 8086 // redeclaration. 8087 Previous.clear(); 8088 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8089 return true; 8090 } 8091 8092 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 8093 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 8094 // declaration. 8095 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 8096 return false; 8097 } else { 8098 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 8099 // translation unit which might conflict. 8100 if (IsGlobal) { 8101 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 8102 IsGlobal = false; 8103 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8104 I != E; ++I) { 8105 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8106 Prev = *I; 8107 break; 8108 } 8109 } 8110 } else { 8111 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 8112 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 8113 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 8114 I != E; ++I) { 8115 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8116 Prev = *I; 8117 break; 8118 } 8119 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 8120 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 8121 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 8122 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 8123 // diagnostic. 8124 } 8125 } 8126 8127 if (!Prev) 8128 return false; 8129 } 8130 8131 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 8132 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 8133 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 8134 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 8135 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 8136 else 8137 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 8138 8139 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 8140 << IsGlobal << ND; 8141 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 8142 << IsGlobal; 8143 return false; 8144 } 8145 8146 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 8147 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 8148 /// 8149 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 8150 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 8151 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 8152 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 8153 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 8154 template<typename T> 8155 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 8156 LookupResult &Previous) { 8157 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8158 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 8159 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 8160 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 8161 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 8162 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 8163 Previous.clear(); 8164 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8165 return true; 8166 } 8167 } 8168 return false; 8169 } 8170 8171 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 8172 // declaration. 8173 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 8174 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 8175 8176 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 8177 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 8178 // in another scope. 8179 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 8180 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 8181 8182 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 8183 return false; 8184 } 8185 8186 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 8187 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8188 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8189 return; 8190 8191 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 8192 8193 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 8194 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 8195 return; 8196 8197 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 8198 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 8199 8200 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 8201 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 8202 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 8203 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 8204 NewVD->setType(T); 8205 } 8206 8207 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 8208 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 8209 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 8210 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 8211 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 8212 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8213 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 8214 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8215 return; 8216 } 8217 8218 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 8219 // scope. 8220 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 8221 !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers", 8222 getLangOpts()) && 8223 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 8224 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 8225 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8226 return; 8227 } 8228 8229 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8230 if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD)) 8231 return; 8232 8233 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 8234 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8235 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 8236 return; 8237 } 8238 8239 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 8240 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 8241 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 8242 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 8243 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 8244 << 0 /*const*/; 8245 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8246 return; 8247 } 8248 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8249 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 8250 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8251 return; 8252 } 8253 } 8254 8255 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 8256 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 8257 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8258 if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() && 8259 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8260 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 8261 getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported( 8262 getLangOpts())))) { 8263 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 8264 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts())) 8265 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8266 << Scope << "global or constant"; 8267 else 8268 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8269 << Scope << "constant"; 8270 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8271 return; 8272 } 8273 } else { 8274 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 8275 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8276 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 8277 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8278 return; 8279 } 8280 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8281 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 8282 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 8283 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 8284 // in functions. 8285 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8286 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8287 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8288 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 8289 else 8290 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8291 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 8292 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8293 return; 8294 } 8295 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 8296 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 8297 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8298 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 8299 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8300 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8301 << "constant"; 8302 else 8303 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8304 << "local"; 8305 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8306 return; 8307 } 8308 } 8309 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 8310 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 8311 // space yet. 8312 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8313 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 8314 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 8315 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8316 return; 8317 } 8318 } 8319 } 8320 8321 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 8322 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8323 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 8324 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 8325 else { 8326 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8327 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 8328 } 8329 } 8330 8331 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 8332 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 8333 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8334 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 8335 8336 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 8337 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 8338 bool SizeIsNegative; 8339 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 8340 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 8341 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 8342 QualType FixedT; 8343 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 8344 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 8345 else if (FixedTInfo) { 8346 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 8347 // both types separately. 8348 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 8349 Oversized); 8350 } 8351 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 8352 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 8353 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 8354 // int a[10][n]; 8355 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 8356 8357 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8358 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 8359 << SizeRange; 8360 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 8361 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 8362 << SizeRange; 8363 else 8364 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 8365 << SizeRange; 8366 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8367 return; 8368 } 8369 8370 if (!FixedTInfo) { 8371 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8372 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 8373 else 8374 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 8375 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8376 return; 8377 } 8378 8379 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8380 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8381 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8382 } 8383 8384 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8385 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8386 // of objects and functions. 8387 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8388 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8389 << T; 8390 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8391 return; 8392 } 8393 } 8394 8395 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8396 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8397 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8398 return; 8399 } 8400 8401 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8402 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8403 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8404 return; 8405 } 8406 8407 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8408 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8409 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8410 return; 8411 } 8412 8413 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8414 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8415 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8416 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8417 return; 8418 } 8419 8420 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8421 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8422 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8423 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8424 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8425 return; 8426 } 8427 } 8428 8429 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8430 /// declaration. 8431 /// 8432 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8433 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8434 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8435 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8436 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8437 /// 8438 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8439 /// 8440 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8441 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8442 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8443 8444 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8445 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8446 return false; 8447 8448 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8449 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8450 if (Previous.empty() && 8451 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8452 Previous.setShadowed(); 8453 8454 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8455 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8456 return true; 8457 } 8458 return false; 8459 } 8460 8461 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8462 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8463 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8464 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden; 8465 8466 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8467 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false, 8468 /*DetectVirtual=*/false); 8469 auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8470 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 8471 DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName(); 8472 8473 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8474 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8475 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8476 CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8477 Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8478 } 8479 8480 for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) { 8481 CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD = 8482 dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl()); 8483 if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() || 8484 IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8485 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8486 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires 8487 // clauses when overriding. 8488 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8489 continue; 8490 8491 if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) { 8492 MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD); 8493 CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD); 8494 CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD); 8495 CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD); 8496 CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD); 8497 } 8498 8499 // A method can only override one function from each base class. We 8500 // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases. 8501 return true; 8502 } 8503 8504 return false; 8505 }; 8506 8507 DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths); 8508 return !Overridden.empty(); 8509 } 8510 8511 namespace { 8512 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8513 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8514 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8515 Scope *S; 8516 Declarator &D; 8517 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8518 bool AddToScope; 8519 }; 8520 } // end anonymous namespace 8521 8522 namespace { 8523 8524 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8525 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8526 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8527 public: 8528 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8529 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8530 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8531 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8532 8533 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8534 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8535 return false; 8536 8537 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8538 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8539 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8540 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8541 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8542 8543 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8544 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8545 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8546 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8547 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8548 return true; 8549 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8550 return true; 8551 } 8552 } 8553 } 8554 8555 return false; 8556 } 8557 8558 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8559 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8560 } 8561 8562 private: 8563 ASTContext &Context; 8564 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8565 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8566 }; 8567 8568 } // end anonymous namespace 8569 8570 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8571 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8572 } 8573 8574 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8575 /// 8576 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8577 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8578 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8579 /// the same name. 8580 /// 8581 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8582 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8583 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8584 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8585 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8586 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8587 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8588 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8589 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8590 TypoCorrection Correction; 8591 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8592 unsigned DiagMsg = 8593 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8594 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8595 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8596 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8597 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8598 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8599 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8600 8601 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8602 if (IsLocalFriend) 8603 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8604 else 8605 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8606 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8607 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8608 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8609 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8610 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8611 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8612 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8613 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8614 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8615 if (FD && 8616 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8617 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8618 // involve a parameter 8619 unsigned ParamNum = 8620 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8621 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8622 } 8623 } 8624 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8625 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8626 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8627 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8628 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8629 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8630 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8631 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8632 Previous.clear(); 8633 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8634 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8635 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8636 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8637 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8638 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8639 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8640 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8641 } 8642 } 8643 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8644 8645 NamedDecl *Result; 8646 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8647 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8648 { 8649 // Trap errors. 8650 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8651 8652 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8653 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8654 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8655 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8656 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8657 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8658 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8659 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8660 8661 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8662 Result = nullptr; 8663 } 8664 8665 if (Result) { 8666 // Determine which correction we picked. 8667 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8668 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8669 I != E; ++I) 8670 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8671 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8672 8673 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8674 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8675 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8676 Correction, 8677 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8678 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8679 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8680 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8681 return Result; 8682 } 8683 8684 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8685 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8686 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8687 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8688 Previous.clear(); 8689 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8690 } 8691 8692 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8693 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8694 8695 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8696 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8697 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8698 8699 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8700 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8701 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8702 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8703 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8704 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8705 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8706 8707 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8708 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8709 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8710 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8711 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8712 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8713 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8714 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8715 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8716 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8717 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8718 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd() 8719 << (NewFDisConst 8720 ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8721 .getConstQualifierLoc()) 8722 : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8723 .getRParenLoc() 8724 .getLocWithOffset(1), 8725 " const")); 8726 } else 8727 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8728 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8729 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8730 } 8731 return nullptr; 8732 } 8733 8734 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8735 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8736 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8737 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8738 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8739 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8740 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8741 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8742 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8743 D.setInvalidType(); 8744 break; 8745 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8746 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8747 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8748 return SC_None; 8749 return SC_Extern; 8750 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8751 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8752 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8753 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8754 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8755 // other than extern 8756 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8757 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8758 diag::err_static_block_func); 8759 break; 8760 } else 8761 return SC_Static; 8762 } 8763 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8764 } 8765 8766 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8767 return SC_None; 8768 } 8769 8770 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8771 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8772 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8773 StorageClass SC, 8774 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8775 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8776 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8777 8778 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8779 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8780 8781 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8782 // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is 8783 // true when: 8784 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8785 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8786 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8787 // function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to 8788 // check this case because attributes may cause a non-function 8789 // declarator to still have a function type. e.g., 8790 // typedef void func(int a); 8791 // __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype 8792 bool HasPrototype = 8793 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8794 (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() && 8795 D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) || 8796 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8797 assert( 8798 (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) && 8799 "Strict prototypes are required"); 8800 8801 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 8802 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8803 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype, 8804 ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified, 8805 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8806 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8807 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8808 8809 return NewFD; 8810 } 8811 8812 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8813 8814 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8815 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) { 8816 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8817 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8818 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 8819 ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified; 8820 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8821 } 8822 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8823 8824 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8825 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8826 // the class has been completely parsed. 8827 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8828 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8829 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8830 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8831 D.setInvalidType(); 8832 8833 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8834 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8835 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8836 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8837 8838 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8839 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8840 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8841 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 8842 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8843 InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8844 8845 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8846 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8847 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8848 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8849 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8850 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8851 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8852 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8853 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8854 TrailingRequiresClause); 8855 8856 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 8857 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 8858 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 8859 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 8860 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 8861 8862 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8863 return NewDD; 8864 8865 } else { 8866 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 8867 D.setInvalidType(); 8868 8869 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 8870 // code path. 8871 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8872 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, 8873 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8874 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8875 } 8876 8877 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 8878 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 8879 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8880 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 8881 return nullptr; 8882 } 8883 8884 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8885 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8886 return nullptr; 8887 8888 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8889 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 8890 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8891 TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8892 ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8893 TrailingRequiresClause); 8894 8895 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 8896 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 8897 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 8898 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 8899 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 8900 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8901 8902 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8903 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8904 D.getEndLoc()); 8905 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 8906 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 8907 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 8908 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 8909 // constructor if it has no return type). 8910 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 8911 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 8912 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 8913 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 8914 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8915 return nullptr; 8916 } 8917 8918 // This is a C++ method declaration. 8919 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 8920 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8921 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8922 ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8923 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 8924 return Ret; 8925 } else { 8926 bool isFriend = 8927 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8928 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 8929 return nullptr; 8930 8931 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8932 // prototype. This true when: 8933 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 8934 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8935 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8936 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8937 true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8938 } 8939 } 8940 8941 enum OpenCLParamType { 8942 ValidKernelParam, 8943 PtrPtrKernelParam, 8944 PtrKernelParam, 8945 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 8946 InvalidKernelParam, 8947 RecordKernelParam 8948 }; 8949 8950 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 8951 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 8952 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 8953 // integers other than by their names. 8954 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 8955 8956 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 8957 // for a size dependent type. 8958 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 8959 do { 8960 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 8961 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 8962 if (Names.end() != Match) 8963 return true; 8964 8965 Ty = DesugaredTy; 8966 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 8967 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 8968 8969 return false; 8970 } 8971 8972 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 8973 if (PT->isDependentType()) 8974 return InvalidKernelParam; 8975 8976 if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) { 8977 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 8978 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 8979 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 8980 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 8981 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 8982 8983 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) { 8984 // This is a pointer to pointer parameter. 8985 // Recursively check inner type. 8986 OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType); 8987 if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam || 8988 ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam) 8989 return ParamKind; 8990 8991 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 8992 } 8993 8994 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 8995 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 8996 // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to 8997 // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters. 8998 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 8999 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9000 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9001 !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() && 9002 !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType()) 9003 return InvalidKernelParam; 9004 9005 return PtrKernelParam; 9006 } 9007 9008 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9009 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9010 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9011 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 9012 // of these built-in scalar types. 9013 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 9014 return InvalidKernelParam; 9015 9016 if (PT->isImageType()) 9017 return PtrKernelParam; 9018 9019 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 9020 return InvalidKernelParam; 9021 9022 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 9023 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 9024 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 9025 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) && 9026 PT->isHalfType()) 9027 return InvalidKernelParam; 9028 9029 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 9030 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 9031 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9032 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 9033 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 9034 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 9035 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 9036 } 9037 9038 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9039 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9040 // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data 9041 // types) for parameters passed by value; 9042 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9043 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9044 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9045 !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context)) 9046 return InvalidKernelParam; 9047 9048 if (PT->isRecordType()) 9049 return RecordKernelParam; 9050 9051 return ValidKernelParam; 9052 } 9053 9054 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 9055 Sema &S, 9056 Declarator &D, 9057 ParmVarDecl *Param, 9058 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 9059 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 9060 9061 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 9062 // used again 9063 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 9064 return; 9065 9066 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 9067 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 9068 // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a: 9069 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer 9070 // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below. 9071 if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) { 9072 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 9073 D.setInvalidType(); 9074 return; 9075 } 9076 9077 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9078 return; 9079 9080 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 9081 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 9082 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 9083 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 9084 // __constant. 9085 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 9086 D.setInvalidType(); 9087 return; 9088 9089 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9090 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9091 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9092 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 9093 // one of these built-in scalar types. 9094 9095 case InvalidKernelParam: 9096 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 9097 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 9098 // of event_t type. 9099 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 9100 // type for any function elsewhere. 9101 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 9102 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9103 9104 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 9105 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 9106 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 9107 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 9108 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 9109 if (Loc.isValid()) 9110 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 9111 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 9112 } 9113 } 9114 9115 D.setInvalidType(); 9116 return; 9117 9118 case PtrKernelParam: 9119 case ValidKernelParam: 9120 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9121 return; 9122 9123 case RecordKernelParam: 9124 break; 9125 } 9126 9127 // Track nested structs we will inspect 9128 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 9129 9130 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 9131 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 9132 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 9133 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 9134 9135 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 9136 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 9137 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 9138 const RecordType *RecTy = 9139 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 9140 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 9141 9142 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 9143 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 9144 9145 do { 9146 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 9147 if (!Next) { 9148 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 9149 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 9150 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 9151 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 9152 9153 continue; 9154 } 9155 9156 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 9157 // field itself) to the history stack. 9158 const RecordDecl *RD; 9159 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 9160 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 9161 9162 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 9163 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 9164 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 9165 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 9166 "Unexpected type."); 9167 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9168 9169 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 9170 } else { 9171 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 9172 } 9173 9174 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 9175 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 9176 9177 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 9178 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 9179 9180 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 9181 continue; 9182 9183 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 9184 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 9185 continue; 9186 9187 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 9188 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 9189 continue; 9190 } 9191 9192 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 9193 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 9194 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 9195 // union. 9196 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 9197 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 9198 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 9199 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 9200 << PT->isUnionType() 9201 << PT; 9202 } else { 9203 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9204 } 9205 9206 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9207 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 9208 9209 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 9210 // the offending field came from 9211 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 9212 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 9213 E = HistoryStack.end(); 9214 I != E; ++I) { 9215 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 9216 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9217 << OuterField->getType(); 9218 } 9219 9220 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 9221 << QT->isPointerType() 9222 << QT; 9223 D.setInvalidType(); 9224 return; 9225 } 9226 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 9227 } 9228 9229 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9230 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9231 /// nothing. 9232 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 9233 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 9234 DC = DC->getParent(); 9235 return DC; 9236 } 9237 9238 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9239 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9240 /// nothing. 9241 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 9242 while (S->isClassScope() || 9243 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 9244 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 9245 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 9246 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 9247 S = S->getParent(); 9248 return S; 9249 } 9250 9251 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std. 9252 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD, 9253 unsigned BuiltinID) { 9254 switch (BuiltinID) { 9255 case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo: 9256 // No type checking whatsoever. 9257 return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 9258 9259 case Builtin::BIaddressof: 9260 case Builtin::BI__addressof: 9261 case Builtin::BIforward: 9262 case Builtin::BImove: 9263 case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept: 9264 case Builtin::BIas_const: { 9265 // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm 9266 // OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt) 9267 // as the builtin std::move. 9268 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9269 return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic(); 9270 } 9271 9272 default: 9273 return false; 9274 } 9275 } 9276 9277 NamedDecl* 9278 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 9279 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 9280 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 9281 bool &AddToScope) { 9282 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 9283 9284 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 9285 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 9286 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 9287 9288 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 9289 llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef); 9290 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 9291 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 9292 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 9293 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 9294 else 9295 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 9296 } 9297 9298 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 9299 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 9300 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 9301 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 9302 9303 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 9304 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9305 diag::err_invalid_thread) 9306 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 9307 9308 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 9309 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 9310 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9311 9312 bool isFriend = false; 9313 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 9314 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 9315 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9316 9317 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 9318 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9319 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 9320 9321 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 9322 9323 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 9324 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 9325 9326 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 9327 isVirtualOkay); 9328 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 9329 9330 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 9331 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 9332 9333 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 9334 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 9335 // context will be different from the semantic context. 9336 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9337 9338 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 9339 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 9340 9341 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9342 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 9343 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 9344 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 9345 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9346 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9347 // C++ [class.friend]p5 9348 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 9349 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 9350 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9351 } 9352 9353 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 9354 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 9355 // return true). 9356 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 9357 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 9358 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 9359 NewFD->setPure(true); 9360 9361 // C++ [class.union]p2 9362 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 9363 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) { 9364 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 9365 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9366 } 9367 if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) && 9368 Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() && 9369 NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() && 9370 NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9371 if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition()) 9372 Def->setInitMethod(true); 9373 } 9374 } 9375 9376 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 9377 isMemberSpecialization = false; 9378 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9379 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9380 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9381 9382 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 9383 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 9384 bool Invalid = false; 9385 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 9386 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 9387 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9388 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 9389 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 9390 ? D.getName().TemplateId 9391 : nullptr, 9392 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 9393 Invalid); 9394 if (TemplateParams) { 9395 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9396 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 9397 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9398 9399 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 9400 // This is a function template 9401 9402 // A destructor cannot be a template. 9403 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 9404 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 9405 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9406 } 9407 9408 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 9409 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 9410 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 9411 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 9412 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 9413 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 9414 Invalid = true; 9415 } 9416 9417 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 9418 NewFD->getLocation(), 9419 Name, TemplateParams, 9420 NewFD); 9421 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9422 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 9423 9424 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 9425 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 9426 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 9427 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 9428 .drop_back(1)); 9429 } 9430 } else { 9431 // This is a function template specialization. 9432 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9433 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9434 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9435 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9436 9437 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 9438 if (isFriend) { 9439 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 9440 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 9441 9442 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 9443 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 9444 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 9445 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 9446 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 9447 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 9448 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9449 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 9450 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 9451 } 9452 9453 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9454 << Name << RemoveRange 9455 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9456 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9457 Invalid = true; 9458 } 9459 } 9460 } else { 9461 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9462 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9463 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9464 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9465 9466 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9467 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9468 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9469 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9470 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9471 } 9472 9473 if (Invalid) { 9474 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9475 if (FunctionTemplate) 9476 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9477 } 9478 9479 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9480 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9481 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9482 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9483 // 9484 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9485 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9486 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9487 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9488 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9489 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9490 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9491 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9492 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9493 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9494 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9495 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9496 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9497 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9498 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9499 } else { 9500 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9501 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9502 } 9503 9504 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9505 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9506 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9507 } 9508 9509 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9510 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9511 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9512 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9513 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9514 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9515 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9516 // thing to do. 9517 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9518 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9519 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9520 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9521 QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType()); 9522 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9523 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9524 } 9525 9526 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9527 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9528 // declaration. 9529 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9530 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9531 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9532 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9533 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9534 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9535 } 9536 } 9537 9538 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9539 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9540 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9541 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9542 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9543 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9544 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9545 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9546 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9547 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9548 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9549 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9550 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9551 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9552 // or conversion function. 9553 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9554 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9555 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9556 } 9557 } 9558 9559 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 9560 if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) { 9561 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9562 // are implicitly inline. 9563 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9564 9565 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9566 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9567 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9568 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9569 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || 9570 ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) { 9571 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9572 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 9573 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 9574 ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified 9575 : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9576 } 9577 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9578 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9579 // specifier. 9580 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval && 9581 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9582 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9583 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9584 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9585 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9586 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9587 << NewFD; 9588 NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9589 } 9590 } 9591 9592 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9593 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9594 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9595 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9596 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9597 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9598 << 0 9599 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9600 } else { 9601 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9602 if (FunctionTemplate) 9603 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9604 } 9605 } 9606 9607 if (isFriend) { 9608 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9609 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9610 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9611 } 9612 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9613 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9614 } 9615 9616 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9617 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9618 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9619 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 9620 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 9621 break; 9622 9623 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 9624 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9625 break; 9626 9627 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 9628 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9629 break; 9630 } 9631 9632 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9633 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9634 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 9635 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9636 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9637 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9638 } 9639 9640 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9641 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9642 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9643 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9644 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9645 // the class. 9646 9647 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9648 // member function definition. 9649 9650 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9651 // member function template declaration and class member template 9652 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9653 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9654 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9655 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9656 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9657 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9658 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9659 } 9660 9661 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9662 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9663 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9664 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9665 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9666 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9667 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9668 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9669 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9670 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9671 } 9672 9673 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9674 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9675 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9676 isMemberSpecialization || 9677 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9678 9679 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9680 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9681 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9682 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9683 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9684 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9685 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9686 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9687 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9688 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9689 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9690 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9691 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9692 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9693 } else 9694 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9695 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9696 } 9697 } 9698 9699 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9700 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9701 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9702 unsigned FTIIdx; 9703 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9704 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9705 9706 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9707 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9708 // single void argument. 9709 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9710 // already checks for that case. 9711 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9712 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9713 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9714 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9715 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9716 Params.push_back(Param); 9717 9718 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9719 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9720 } 9721 } 9722 9723 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9724 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9725 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9726 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9727 // the TU. 9728 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9729 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9730 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9731 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9732 9733 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9734 // instead. 9735 if (!TD) { 9736 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9737 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9738 } 9739 if (!TD) 9740 continue; 9741 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9742 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9743 continue; 9744 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9745 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9746 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9747 9748 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9749 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9750 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9751 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9752 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9753 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9754 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9755 } 9756 } 9757 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9758 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9759 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9760 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9761 // 9762 // @code 9763 // typedef void fn(int); 9764 // fn f; 9765 // @endcode 9766 9767 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9768 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9769 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9770 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9771 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9772 Params.push_back(Param); 9773 } 9774 } else { 9775 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9776 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9777 } 9778 9779 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9780 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9781 9782 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9783 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9784 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9785 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9786 9787 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9788 // because all functions have linkage. 9789 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9790 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9791 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9792 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9793 } 9794 9795 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9796 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9797 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9798 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9799 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9800 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9801 9802 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9803 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9804 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9805 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9806 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9807 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9808 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9809 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9810 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9811 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9812 NewFD)) 9813 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9814 } 9815 9816 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9817 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9818 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9819 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9820 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9821 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9822 } 9823 } 9824 9825 // Handle attributes. 9826 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9827 9828 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9829 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9830 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9831 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9832 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9833 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9834 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9835 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9836 } 9837 } 9838 9839 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9840 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9841 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9842 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9843 9844 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9845 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9846 9847 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9848 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9849 isMemberSpecialization, 9850 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 9851 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9852 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9853 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9854 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9855 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9856 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9857 9858 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 9859 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 9860 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 9861 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 9862 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9863 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 9864 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 9865 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 9866 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 9867 int DiagID = 9868 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 9869 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 9870 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 9871 } 9872 } 9873 9874 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 9875 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 9876 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 9877 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9878 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 9879 } else { 9880 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 9881 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 9882 // 9883 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 9884 // 9885 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 9886 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 9887 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 9888 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 9889 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9890 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9891 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 9892 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 9893 9894 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 9895 // argument list into our AST format. 9896 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9897 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 9898 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 9899 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9900 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 9901 TemplateId->NumArgs); 9902 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 9903 TemplateArgs); 9904 9905 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9906 9907 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9908 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9909 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 9910 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 9911 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 9912 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9913 9914 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9915 } else { 9916 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 9917 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 9918 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 9919 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 9920 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9921 } 9922 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9923 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 9924 // wrote something like: 9925 // template <> friend void foo(int); 9926 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 9927 // friend void foo<>(int); 9928 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 9929 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9930 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9931 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9932 } 9933 9934 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 9935 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 9936 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 9937 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 9938 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 9939 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 9940 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 9941 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 9942 9943 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 9944 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 9945 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 9946 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 9947 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 9948 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 9949 TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( 9950 TemplateArgs.arguments()))) { 9951 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 9952 "friend function specialization without template args"); 9953 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 9954 Previous)) 9955 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9956 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9957 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 9958 && !isFriend) { 9959 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 9960 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9961 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9962 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 9963 Previous)) 9964 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9965 9966 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 9967 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 9968 // specialization (14.7.3) 9969 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 9970 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 9971 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 9972 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 9973 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9974 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 9975 << SC 9976 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9977 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9978 9979 else 9980 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9981 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 9982 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9983 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9984 } 9985 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 9986 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 9987 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9988 } 9989 9990 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9991 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 9992 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9993 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9994 9995 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9996 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9997 9998 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9999 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 10000 isMemberSpecialization, 10001 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 10002 else if (!Previous.empty()) 10003 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 10004 D.setRedeclaration(true); 10005 } 10006 10007 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 10008 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 10009 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 10010 10011 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 10012 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 10013 : NewFD); 10014 10015 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 10016 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 10017 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10018 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 10019 10020 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 10021 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 10022 } 10023 10024 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 10025 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 10026 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 10027 10028 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 10029 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 10030 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10031 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 10032 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 10033 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 10034 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 10035 : nullptr, 10036 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 10037 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 10038 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 10039 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 10040 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 10041 DC && DC->isRecord() && 10042 DC->isDependentContext()) 10043 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 10044 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 10045 } 10046 10047 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10048 // Ignore all the rest of this. 10049 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10050 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 10051 AddToScope }; 10052 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 10053 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 10054 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 10055 10056 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 10057 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 10058 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 10059 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 10060 10061 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 10062 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 10063 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 10064 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 10065 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 10066 // can actually do this check immediately. 10067 // 10068 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 10069 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 10070 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 10071 if (isFriend && 10072 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 10073 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 10074 // ignore these 10075 } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 10076 NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) { 10077 // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new 10078 // versions of the function. 10079 } else { 10080 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 10081 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 10082 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 10083 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 10084 // 10085 // class X { 10086 // void f() const; 10087 // }; 10088 // 10089 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 10090 // 10091 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 10092 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 10093 // whether the parameter types are references). 10094 10095 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10096 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 10097 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10098 return Result; 10099 } 10100 } 10101 10102 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 10103 // to something. 10104 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 10105 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10106 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 10107 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10108 return Result; 10109 } 10110 } 10111 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 10112 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 10113 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 10114 !isMemberSpecialization) { 10115 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 10116 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 10117 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 10118 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 10119 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 10120 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 10121 // generate them. 10122 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 10123 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 10124 } 10125 } 10126 10127 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 10128 // attributes as appropriate. 10129 if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10130 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 10131 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 10132 bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID); 10133 if (!InStdNamespace && 10134 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 10135 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 10136 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 10137 // matching regardless of its declared type. 10138 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 10139 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10140 } else { 10141 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 10142 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 10143 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 10144 10145 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 10146 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 10147 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 10148 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10149 } 10150 } 10151 } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() && 10152 isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) { 10153 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10154 } 10155 } 10156 } 10157 } 10158 10159 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 10160 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 10161 10162 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 10163 10164 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 10165 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10166 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10167 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 10168 << NewFD; 10169 10170 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 10171 const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 10172 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 10173 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 10174 EPI.Variadic = true; 10175 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 10176 10177 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 10178 NewFD->setType(R); 10179 } 10180 10181 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 10182 // member, set the visibility of this function. 10183 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 10184 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 10185 10186 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 10187 // marking the function. 10188 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 10189 10190 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any 10191 // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma. 10192 if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 10193 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 10194 AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD); 10195 AddSectionMSAllocText(NewFD); 10196 } 10197 10198 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 10199 // the map of such variables. 10200 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10201 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 10202 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 10203 10204 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 10205 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 10206 10207 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 10208 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10209 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 10210 isMemberSpecialization || 10211 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 10212 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 10213 } 10214 10215 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 10216 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 10217 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 10218 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10219 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 10220 if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 10221 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 10222 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 10223 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 10224 } 10225 10226 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 10227 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 10228 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 10229 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 10230 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 10231 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 10232 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 10233 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 10234 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 10235 } 10236 } 10237 10238 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 10239 10240 10241 10242 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 10243 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 10244 if (SC == SC_Static) { 10245 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 10246 D.setInvalidType(); 10247 } 10248 10249 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 10250 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 10251 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 10252 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 10253 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 10254 : FixItHint()); 10255 D.setInvalidType(); 10256 } 10257 10258 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 10259 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 10260 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 10261 10262 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10263 if (DC->isRecord()) { 10264 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 10265 D.setInvalidType(); 10266 } 10267 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10268 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 10269 D.setInvalidType(); 10270 } 10271 } 10272 } 10273 10274 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10275 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10276 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10277 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 10278 return FunctionTemplate; 10279 } 10280 10281 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10282 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 10283 } 10284 10285 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 10286 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 10287 10288 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 10289 // types. 10290 if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) { 10291 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 10292 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 10293 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 10294 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 10295 D.setInvalidType(); 10296 } 10297 } 10298 } 10299 } 10300 10301 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 10302 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 10303 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 10304 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10305 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 10306 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 10307 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 10308 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 10309 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 10310 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 10311 AddToScope = false; 10312 } 10313 10314 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 10315 // that are run during load/unload. 10316 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 10317 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 10318 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10319 << 1; 10320 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10321 } 10322 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 10323 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10324 << 2; 10325 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10326 } 10327 } 10328 10329 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 10330 // definition. 10331 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 10332 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 10333 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 10334 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 10335 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 10336 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 10337 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 10338 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 10339 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 10340 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 10341 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 10342 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10343 break; 10344 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 10345 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 10346 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10347 break; 10348 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 10349 break; 10350 } 10351 10352 return NewFD; 10353 } 10354 10355 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 10356 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 10357 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 10358 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 10359 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 10360 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 10361 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 10362 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 10363 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 10364 /// available since MS has removed the page. 10365 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10366 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 10367 if (!Method) 10368 return nullptr; 10369 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 10370 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10371 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10372 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10373 return NewAttr; 10374 } 10375 10376 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 10377 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 10378 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10379 return nullptr; 10380 10381 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 10382 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10383 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10384 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10385 return NewAttr; 10386 } 10387 } 10388 return nullptr; 10389 } 10390 10391 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 10392 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 10393 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 10394 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 10395 /// 10396 /// \param FD Function being declared. 10397 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 10398 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 10399 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 10400 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10401 bool IsDefinition) { 10402 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 10403 return A; 10404 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 10405 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10406 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 10407 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 10408 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 10409 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 10410 return nullptr; 10411 } 10412 10413 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 10414 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 10415 /// best-effort check. 10416 /// 10417 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 10418 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 10419 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 10420 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 10421 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 10422 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 10423 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10424 return true; 10425 10426 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 10427 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 10428 // 10429 // int f(); 10430 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 10431 // 10432 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 10433 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 10434 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 10435 return false; 10436 10437 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 10438 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 10439 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 10440 return false; 10441 10442 return true; 10443 } 10444 10445 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 10446 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 10447 /// 10448 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 10449 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 10450 /// same declaration name. 10451 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 10452 /// belongs to. 10453 /// 10454 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 10455 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10456 return true; 10457 10458 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 10459 // permit cases like 10460 // 10461 // void func(); 10462 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 10463 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10464 // 10465 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10466 // 10467 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10468 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10469 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10470 // the way of access checks. 10471 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10472 return false; 10473 10474 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10475 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10476 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10477 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10478 PrevVD->getType()); 10479 } 10480 10481 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10482 /// validity. 10483 /// 10484 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10485 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10486 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10487 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10488 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10489 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10490 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10491 10492 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10493 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10494 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10495 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10496 return true; 10497 } 10498 10499 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10500 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10501 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10502 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10503 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10504 return true; 10505 } 10506 10507 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10508 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10509 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10510 << Feature << BareFeat; 10511 return true; 10512 } 10513 } 10514 return false; 10515 } 10516 10517 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10518 // multiversion functions. 10519 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10520 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10521 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10522 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10523 switch (Kind) { 10524 default: 10525 return false; 10526 case attr::Used: 10527 return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10528 case attr::NonNull: 10529 case attr::NoThrow: 10530 return true; 10531 } 10532 } 10533 10534 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10535 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10536 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10537 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10538 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10539 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10540 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A; 10541 if (CausedFD) 10542 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10543 return true; 10544 }; 10545 10546 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10547 switch (A->getKind()) { 10548 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10549 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10550 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10551 MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10552 return Diagnose(S, A); 10553 break; 10554 case attr::Target: 10555 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10556 return Diagnose(S, A); 10557 break; 10558 case attr::TargetClones: 10559 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) 10560 return Diagnose(S, A); 10561 break; 10562 default: 10563 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind)) 10564 return Diagnose(S, A); 10565 break; 10566 } 10567 } 10568 return false; 10569 } 10570 10571 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10572 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10573 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10574 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10575 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10576 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10577 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10578 enum DoesntSupport { 10579 FuncTemplates = 0, 10580 VirtFuncs = 1, 10581 DeducedReturn = 2, 10582 Constructors = 3, 10583 Destructors = 4, 10584 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10585 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10586 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10587 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10588 Lambda = 9, 10589 }; 10590 enum Different { 10591 CallingConv = 0, 10592 ReturnType = 1, 10593 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10594 InlineSpec = 3, 10595 Linkage = 4, 10596 LanguageLinkage = 5, 10597 }; 10598 10599 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10600 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10601 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10602 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10603 return true; 10604 } 10605 10606 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10607 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10608 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10609 10610 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10611 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10612 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10613 << FuncTemplates; 10614 10615 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10616 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10617 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10618 << VirtFuncs; 10619 10620 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10621 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10622 << Constructors; 10623 10624 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10625 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10626 << Destructors; 10627 } 10628 10629 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10630 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10631 << DeletedFuncs; 10632 10633 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10634 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10635 << DefaultedFuncs; 10636 10637 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10638 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10639 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10640 10641 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10642 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10643 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10644 10645 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10646 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10647 << DeducedReturn; 10648 10649 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10650 if (OldFD) { 10651 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10652 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10653 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10654 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10655 10656 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10657 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10658 10659 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10660 10661 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10662 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10663 10664 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10665 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10666 10667 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10668 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10669 10670 if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage()) 10671 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10672 10673 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10674 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage; 10675 10676 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10677 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10678 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10679 return true; 10680 } 10681 return false; 10682 } 10683 10684 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10685 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10686 bool CausesMV, 10687 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10688 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10689 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10690 if (OldFD) 10691 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10692 return true; 10693 } 10694 10695 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind = 10696 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10697 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10698 10699 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10700 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind)) 10701 return true; 10702 10703 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind)) 10704 return true; 10705 10706 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10707 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10708 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10709 10710 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10711 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10712 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10713 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10714 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10715 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10716 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)), 10717 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10718 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10719 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10720 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind, 10721 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10722 } 10723 10724 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10725 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10726 /// 10727 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10728 /// 10729 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10730 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10731 MultiVersionKind MVKind, 10732 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10733 assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 10734 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10735 10736 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10737 // function. 10738 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10739 return false; 10740 10741 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10742 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10743 return true; 10744 } 10745 10746 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) { 10747 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10748 return true; 10749 } 10750 10751 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10752 return false; 10753 } 10754 10755 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10756 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10757 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10758 return true; 10759 } 10760 10761 return false; 10762 } 10763 10764 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10765 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10766 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) { 10767 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10768 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10769 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10770 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10771 10772 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10773 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10774 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10775 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10776 return false; 10777 10778 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10779 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10780 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10781 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10782 return true; 10783 } 10784 10785 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10786 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10787 return true; 10788 } 10789 10790 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10791 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10792 Redeclaration = true; 10793 OldDecl = OldFD; 10794 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10795 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10796 return false; 10797 } 10798 10799 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10800 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10801 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10802 return true; 10803 } 10804 10805 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10806 10807 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10808 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10809 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10810 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10811 return true; 10812 } 10813 10814 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10815 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10816 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10817 // nothing after the fact. 10818 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10819 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10820 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10821 << 0; 10822 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10823 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10824 return true; 10825 } 10826 } 10827 10828 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10829 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10830 Redeclaration = false; 10831 OldDecl = nullptr; 10832 Previous.clear(); 10833 return false; 10834 } 10835 10836 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old, 10837 MultiVersionKind New) { 10838 if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None || 10839 New == MultiVersionKind::None) 10840 return true; 10841 10842 return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10843 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) || 10844 (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && 10845 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch); 10846 } 10847 10848 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 10849 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 10850 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10851 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10852 MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10853 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 10854 const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 10855 LookupResult &Previous) { 10856 10857 MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10858 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 10859 if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) { 10860 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10861 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10862 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10863 return true; 10864 } 10865 10866 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 10867 if (NewTA) { 10868 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10869 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10870 } 10871 10872 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 10873 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 10874 10875 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = 10876 AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD); 10877 10878 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 10879 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 10880 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 10881 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 10882 if (!CurFD) 10883 continue; 10884 if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 10885 S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 10886 continue; 10887 10888 switch (NewMVKind) { 10889 case MultiVersionKind::None: 10890 assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones && 10891 "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations"); 10892 break; 10893 case MultiVersionKind::Target: { 10894 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10895 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 10896 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10897 Redeclaration = true; 10898 OldDecl = ND; 10899 return false; 10900 } 10901 10902 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10903 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 10904 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10905 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10906 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10907 return true; 10908 } 10909 break; 10910 } 10911 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: { 10912 const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 10913 Redeclaration = true; 10914 OldDecl = CurFD; 10915 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10916 10917 if (CurClones && NewClones && 10918 (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() || 10919 !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(), 10920 CurClones->featuresStrs_end(), 10921 NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) { 10922 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match); 10923 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10924 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10925 return true; 10926 } 10927 10928 return false; 10929 } 10930 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 10931 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: { 10932 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10933 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10934 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 10935 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 10936 // the redeclaration errors. 10937 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10938 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 10939 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 10940 std::equal( 10941 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 10942 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 10943 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10944 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10945 })) { 10946 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10947 Redeclaration = true; 10948 OldDecl = ND; 10949 return false; 10950 } 10951 10952 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 10953 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 10954 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10955 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10956 return true; 10957 } 10958 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 10959 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 10960 std::equal( 10961 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 10962 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 10963 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10964 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10965 })) { 10966 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10967 Redeclaration = true; 10968 OldDecl = ND; 10969 return false; 10970 } 10971 10972 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 10973 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10974 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10975 if (CurII == NewII) { 10976 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 10977 << NewII; 10978 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10979 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10980 return true; 10981 } 10982 } 10983 } 10984 } 10985 break; 10986 } 10987 } 10988 } 10989 10990 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 10991 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 10992 // handled in the attribute adding step. 10993 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10994 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10995 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10996 return true; 10997 } 10998 10999 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 11000 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) { 11001 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11002 return true; 11003 } 11004 11005 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 11006 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11007 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11008 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11009 Redeclaration = true; 11010 OldDecl = OldFD; 11011 return false; 11012 } 11013 11014 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11015 Redeclaration = false; 11016 OldDecl = nullptr; 11017 Previous.clear(); 11018 return false; 11019 } 11020 11021 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 11022 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 11023 /// 11024 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11025 /// 11026 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 11027 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11028 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 11029 LookupResult &Previous) { 11030 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11031 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 11032 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 11033 const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 11034 MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 11035 11036 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 11037 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 11038 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 11039 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 11040 !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) { 11041 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 11042 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11043 return true; 11044 } 11045 return false; 11046 } 11047 11048 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 11049 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 11050 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 11051 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 11052 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 11053 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11054 return false; 11055 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA); 11056 } 11057 11058 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 11059 11060 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11061 return false; 11062 11063 // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except 11064 // for target_clones. 11065 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None && 11066 OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) { 11067 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 11068 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 11069 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11070 return true; 11071 } 11072 11073 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11074 switch (MVKind) { 11075 case MultiVersionKind::Target: 11076 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 11077 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11078 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: 11079 if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) { 11080 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11081 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 11082 } 11083 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11084 break; 11085 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: 11086 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 11087 case MultiVersionKind::None: 11088 break; 11089 } 11090 } 11091 11092 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 11093 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 11094 // still compatible with previous declarations. 11095 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA, 11096 NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones, 11097 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11098 } 11099 11100 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 11101 /// 11102 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 11103 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 11104 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 11105 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 11106 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 11107 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 11108 /// via InstantiateDecl). 11109 /// 11110 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 11111 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 11112 /// previous declaration). 11113 /// 11114 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11115 /// 11116 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 11117 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11118 LookupResult &Previous, 11119 bool IsMemberSpecialization, 11120 bool DeclIsDefn) { 11121 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 11122 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 11123 11124 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 11125 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 11126 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 11127 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11128 !Previous.isShadowed(); 11129 11130 bool Redeclaration = false; 11131 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 11132 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 11133 11134 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 11135 // the same name, if appropriate. 11136 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11137 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 11138 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 11139 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 11140 // function to the scope. 11141 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 11142 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 11143 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 11144 Redeclaration = true; 11145 OldDecl = Candidate; 11146 } 11147 } else { 11148 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11149 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 11150 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 11151 case Ovl_Match: 11152 Redeclaration = true; 11153 break; 11154 11155 case Ovl_NonFunction: 11156 Redeclaration = true; 11157 break; 11158 11159 case Ovl_Overload: 11160 Redeclaration = false; 11161 break; 11162 } 11163 } 11164 } 11165 11166 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 11167 if (!Redeclaration && 11168 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 11169 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11170 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 11171 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 11172 Redeclaration = true; 11173 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11174 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 11175 11176 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 11177 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 11178 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11179 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 11180 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11181 Redeclaration = false; 11182 OldDecl = nullptr; 11183 } 11184 } 11185 } 11186 } 11187 11188 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous)) 11189 return Redeclaration; 11190 11191 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 11192 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 11193 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 11194 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11195 } 11196 11197 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 11198 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 11199 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 11200 // 11201 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 11202 // definition of a static member function. 11203 // 11204 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 11205 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 11206 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 11207 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 11208 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 11209 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 11210 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 11211 if (OldDecl) 11212 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 11213 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 11214 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 11215 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11216 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 11217 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 11218 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 11219 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 11220 11221 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 11222 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 11223 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11224 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 11225 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 11226 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 11227 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 11228 11229 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 11230 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 11231 } 11232 } 11233 } 11234 11235 if (Redeclaration) { 11236 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 11237 // merged. 11238 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious, 11239 DeclIsDefn)) { 11240 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11241 return Redeclaration; 11242 } 11243 11244 Previous.clear(); 11245 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 11246 11247 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 11248 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 11249 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 11250 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 11251 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 11252 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 11253 11254 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 11255 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 11256 // can add it as a redeclaration. 11257 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 11258 11259 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11260 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 11261 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11262 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11263 } 11264 11265 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 11266 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 11267 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 11268 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 11269 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 11270 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 11271 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 11272 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 11273 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 11274 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 11275 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 11276 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 11277 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 11278 } 11279 } 11280 11281 } else { 11282 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 11283 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 11284 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 11285 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11286 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 11287 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 11288 } 11289 } 11290 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 11291 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11292 assert((Previous.empty() || 11293 llvm::any_of(Previous, 11294 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11295 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11296 })) && 11297 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 11298 11299 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11300 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 11301 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11302 }); 11303 11304 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 11305 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11306 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 11307 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 11308 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 11309 << false; 11310 11311 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 11312 } 11313 } 11314 11315 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 11316 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD); 11317 11318 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 11319 11320 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11321 // C++-specific checks. 11322 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11323 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 11324 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11325 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11326 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 11327 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 11328 11329 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 11330 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 11331 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 11332 DeclarationName Name 11333 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 11334 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 11335 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 11336 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 11337 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11338 return Redeclaration; 11339 } 11340 } 11341 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 11342 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 11343 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 11344 11345 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 11346 // explicitly specialized. 11347 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 11348 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 11349 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 11350 } 11351 11352 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 11353 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 11354 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 11355 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 11356 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 11357 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 11358 } 11359 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 11360 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 11361 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 11362 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 11363 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 11364 11365 if (Method->isStatic()) 11366 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 11367 } 11368 11369 // C++20: dcl.decl.general p4: 11370 // The optional requires-clause ([temp.pre]) in an init-declarator or 11371 // member-declarator shall be present only if the declarator declares a 11372 // templated function ([dcl.fct]). 11373 if (Expr *TRC = NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 11374 if (!NewFD->isTemplated() && !NewFD->isTemplateInstantiation()) 11375 Diag(TRC->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_constrained_non_templated_function); 11376 } 11377 11378 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 11379 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 11380 11381 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 11382 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 11383 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11384 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11385 return Redeclaration; 11386 } 11387 11388 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 11389 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 11390 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11391 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11392 return Redeclaration; 11393 } 11394 11395 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 11396 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 11397 // during delayed parsing anyway. 11398 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 11399 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 11400 11401 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 11402 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 11403 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 11404 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 11405 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 11406 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 11407 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 11408 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 11409 << NewFD << R; 11410 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 11411 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11412 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 11413 } 11414 11415 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 11416 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 11417 // [is] part of the function type 11418 // 11419 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 11420 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 11421 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 11422 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 11423 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 11424 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 11425 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 11426 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 11427 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 11428 // restricted prior to C++17. 11429 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11430 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 11431 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 11432 T = T->getPointeeType(); 11433 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11434 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 11435 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11436 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 11437 return true; 11438 return false; 11439 }; 11440 11441 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11442 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 11443 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 11444 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 11445 if (AnyNoexcept) 11446 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11447 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 11448 << NewFD; 11449 } 11450 11451 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 11452 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 11453 } 11454 return Redeclaration; 11455 } 11456 11457 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 11458 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 11459 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 11460 // constexpr is ill-formed. 11461 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 11462 // appear in a declaration of main. 11463 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 11464 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 11465 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 11466 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11467 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 11468 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 11469 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 11470 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 11471 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 11472 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 11473 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 11474 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 11475 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 11476 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 11477 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 11478 } 11479 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 11480 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 11481 << FD->isConsteval() 11482 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 11483 FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified); 11484 } 11485 11486 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 11487 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 11488 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 11489 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11490 return; 11491 } 11492 11493 // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific 11494 // signatures they are required to conform to. 11495 if (getLangOpts().HLSL) 11496 return; 11497 11498 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11499 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11500 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11501 11502 // Set default calling convention for main() 11503 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11504 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11505 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11506 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11507 } 11508 11509 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11510 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11511 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11512 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11513 11514 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11515 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11516 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11517 else { 11518 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11519 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11520 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11521 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11522 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11523 } 11524 } else { 11525 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11526 // set the flag which tells us that. 11527 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11528 11529 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11530 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11531 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11532 else { 11533 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11534 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11535 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11536 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11537 : FixItHint()); 11538 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11539 } 11540 } 11541 11542 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11543 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11544 11545 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11546 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11547 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11548 11549 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11550 11551 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11552 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11553 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11554 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11555 } 11556 11557 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11558 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11559 // getting shifty. 11560 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11561 HasExtraParameters = false; 11562 11563 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11564 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11565 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11566 nparams = 3; 11567 } 11568 11569 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11570 // if we had some location information about types. 11571 11572 QualType CharPP = 11573 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11574 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11575 11576 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11577 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11578 11579 bool mismatch = true; 11580 11581 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11582 mismatch = false; 11583 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11584 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11585 // char const ** 11586 // char const * const * 11587 // char * const * 11588 11589 QualifierCollector qs; 11590 const PointerType* PT; 11591 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11592 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11593 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11594 Context.CharTy)) { 11595 qs.removeConst(); 11596 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11597 } 11598 } 11599 11600 if (mismatch) { 11601 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11602 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11603 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11604 } 11605 } 11606 11607 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11608 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11609 } 11610 11611 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11612 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11613 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11614 } 11615 } 11616 11617 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) { 11618 11619 // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl 11620 if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain") 11621 return false; 11622 11623 // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl 11624 const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 11625 if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) 11626 return false; 11627 11628 // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain 11629 // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows 11630 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86) 11631 return true; 11632 11633 return false; 11634 } 11635 11636 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11637 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11638 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11639 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11640 11641 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11642 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11643 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11644 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11645 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11646 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11647 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11648 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11649 11650 // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points 11651 if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) { 11652 if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) { 11653 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) { 11654 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType( 11655 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall)); 11656 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11657 } 11658 } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11659 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, 11660 FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11661 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11662 } 11663 } 11664 11665 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11666 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11667 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11668 } 11669 } 11670 11671 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11672 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11673 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11674 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11675 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11676 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11677 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11678 // 11679 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11680 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11681 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11682 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11683 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11684 return true; 11685 } 11686 const Expr *Culprit; 11687 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11688 return false; 11689 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11690 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11691 return true; 11692 } 11693 11694 namespace { 11695 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11696 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11697 class SelfReferenceChecker 11698 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11699 Sema &S; 11700 Decl *OrigDecl; 11701 bool isRecordType; 11702 bool isPODType; 11703 bool isReferenceType; 11704 11705 bool isInitList; 11706 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11707 11708 public: 11709 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11710 11711 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11712 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11713 isPODType = false; 11714 isRecordType = false; 11715 isReferenceType = false; 11716 isInitList = false; 11717 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11718 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11719 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11720 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11721 } 11722 } 11723 11724 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11725 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11726 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11727 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11728 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11729 if (!InitList) { 11730 Visit(E); 11731 return; 11732 } 11733 11734 // Track and increment the index here. 11735 isInitList = true; 11736 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11737 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11738 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11739 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11740 } 11741 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11742 } 11743 11744 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11745 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11746 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11747 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11748 Expr *Base = E; 11749 bool ReferenceField = false; 11750 11751 // Get the field members used. 11752 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11753 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11754 if (!FD) 11755 return false; 11756 Fields.push_back(FD); 11757 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11758 ReferenceField = true; 11759 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11760 } 11761 11762 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11763 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11764 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11765 return false; 11766 11767 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11768 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11769 return true; 11770 11771 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11772 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11773 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11774 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11775 11776 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11777 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11778 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11779 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11780 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11781 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11782 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11783 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11784 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11785 return true; 11786 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11787 break; 11788 } 11789 11790 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11791 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11792 return true; 11793 } 11794 11795 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11796 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11797 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11798 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11799 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11800 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11801 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11802 return; 11803 } 11804 11805 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11806 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11807 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11808 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11809 return; 11810 } 11811 11812 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11813 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11814 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11815 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11816 return; 11817 } 11818 11819 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11820 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11821 return; 11822 } 11823 11824 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11825 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11826 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11827 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11828 return; 11829 } 11830 } 11831 11832 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11833 if (isInitList) { 11834 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11835 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11836 return; 11837 } 11838 11839 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11840 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11841 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 11842 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11843 return; 11844 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11845 } 11846 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 11847 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11848 return; 11849 } 11850 11851 Visit(E); 11852 } 11853 11854 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 11855 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 11856 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11857 if (isReferenceType) 11858 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 11859 } 11860 11861 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 11862 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 11863 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11864 return; 11865 } 11866 11867 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 11868 } 11869 11870 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 11871 if (isInitList) { 11872 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 11873 return; 11874 } 11875 11876 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 11877 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 11878 11879 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 11880 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 11881 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 11882 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 11883 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11884 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11885 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11886 Warn = false; 11887 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11888 } 11889 11890 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 11891 if (Warn) 11892 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11893 return; 11894 } 11895 11896 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 11897 // Visit that expression. 11898 Visit(Base); 11899 } 11900 11901 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 11902 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 11903 11904 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 11905 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 11906 11907 Visit(Callee); 11908 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 11909 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11910 } 11911 11912 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11913 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 11914 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 11915 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 11916 if (!isPODType) 11917 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11918 return; 11919 } 11920 11921 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 11922 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11923 return; 11924 } 11925 11926 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 11927 } 11928 11929 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 11930 11931 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 11932 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 11933 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 11934 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11935 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 11936 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 11937 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11938 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 11939 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11940 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 11941 return; 11942 } 11943 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 11944 } 11945 11946 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 11947 // Treat std::move as a use. 11948 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 11949 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 11950 return; 11951 } 11952 11953 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 11954 } 11955 11956 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 11957 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 11958 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 11959 Visit(E->getRHS()); 11960 return; 11961 } 11962 11963 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 11964 } 11965 11966 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 11967 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 11968 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 11969 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 11970 Visit(E->getCond()); 11971 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 11972 } 11973 11974 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 11975 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 11976 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 11977 unsigned diag; 11978 if (isReferenceType) { 11979 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 11980 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 11981 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 11982 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11983 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11984 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 11985 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 11986 } else { 11987 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 11988 return; 11989 } 11990 11991 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 11992 S.PDiag(diag) 11993 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 11994 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 11995 } 11996 }; 11997 11998 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 11999 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 12000 bool DirectInit) { 12001 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 12002 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 12003 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 12004 return; 12005 12006 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 12007 12008 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 12009 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 12010 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 12011 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 12012 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 12013 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 12014 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 12015 return; 12016 12017 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 12018 } 12019 } // end anonymous namespace 12020 12021 namespace { 12022 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 12023 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 12024 struct VarDeclOrName { 12025 VarDecl *VDecl; 12026 DeclarationName Name; 12027 12028 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 12029 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 12030 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 12031 } 12032 }; 12033 } // end anonymous namespace 12034 12035 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 12036 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 12037 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 12038 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 12039 Expr *Init) { 12040 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 12041 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 12042 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 12043 12044 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 12045 12046 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 12047 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 12048 12049 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 12050 if (!Init) { 12051 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 12052 12053 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 12054 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 12055 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 12056 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 12057 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12058 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 12059 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 12060 return QualType(); 12061 } 12062 } 12063 12064 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 12065 if (Init) 12066 DeduceInits = Init; 12067 12068 if (DirectInit) { 12069 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 12070 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 12071 } 12072 12073 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 12074 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 12075 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12076 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12077 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12078 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 12079 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 12080 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 12081 InitsCopy); 12082 } 12083 12084 if (DirectInit) { 12085 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12086 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 12087 } 12088 12089 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 12090 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 12091 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 12092 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 12093 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12094 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 12095 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 12096 << VN << Type << Range; 12097 return QualType(); 12098 } 12099 12100 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 12101 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 12102 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 12103 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 12104 << VN << Type << Range; 12105 return QualType(); 12106 } 12107 12108 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 12109 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 12110 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12111 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 12112 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 12113 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 12114 return QualType(); 12115 } 12116 12117 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 12118 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 12119 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 12120 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 12121 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12122 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12123 return QualType(); 12124 } 12125 Init = Result.get(); 12126 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 12127 } 12128 12129 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 12130 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 12131 // is present, e has type cv A 12132 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 12133 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 12134 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 12135 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 12136 Type.getQualifiers()); 12137 12138 QualType DeducedType; 12139 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 12140 if (!IsInitCapture) 12141 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 12142 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12143 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 12144 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 12145 << VN 12146 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12147 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12148 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12149 else 12150 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 12151 << VN << TSI->getType() 12152 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12153 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12154 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12155 } 12156 12157 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 12158 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 12159 // checks. 12160 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 12161 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 12162 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 12163 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 12164 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 12165 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 12166 } 12167 12168 return DeducedType; 12169 } 12170 12171 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 12172 Expr *Init) { 12173 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 12174 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 12175 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 12176 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 12177 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 12178 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12179 return true; 12180 } 12181 12182 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 12183 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 12184 12185 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 12186 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 12187 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12188 12189 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 12190 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 12191 12192 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 12193 // the previously declared type. 12194 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 12195 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 12196 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 12197 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 12198 } 12199 12200 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 12201 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 12202 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 12203 } 12204 12205 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 12206 SourceLocation Loc) { 12207 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12208 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 12209 12210 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 12211 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 12212 12213 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12214 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12215 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12216 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 12217 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12218 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 12219 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 12220 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12221 continue; 12222 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 12223 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 12224 } 12225 return; 12226 } 12227 12228 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 12229 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12230 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 12231 NTCUK_Init); 12232 } else { 12233 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 12234 // object. 12235 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 12236 // copy-elision. 12237 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12238 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 12239 } 12240 } 12241 12242 namespace { 12243 12244 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 12245 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 12246 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 12247 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 12248 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 12249 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 12250 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 12251 } 12252 12253 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 12254 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12255 void> { 12256 using Super = 12257 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12258 void>; 12259 12260 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 12261 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12262 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12263 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12264 12265 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 12266 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12267 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12268 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12269 InNonTrivialUnion); 12270 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12271 } 12272 12273 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12274 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12275 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12276 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12277 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12278 } 12279 12280 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12281 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12282 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12283 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12284 } 12285 12286 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12287 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12288 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12289 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12290 bool IsUnion = false; 12291 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12292 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12293 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12294 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12295 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12296 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12297 } 12298 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12299 } 12300 12301 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12302 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12303 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12304 12305 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12306 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12307 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12308 } 12309 12310 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12311 12312 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12313 // non-trivial C union. 12314 QualType OrigTy; 12315 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12316 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12317 Sema &S; 12318 }; 12319 12320 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 12321 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 12322 using Super = 12323 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 12324 12325 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 12326 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12327 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12328 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12329 12330 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 12331 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12332 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12333 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12334 InNonTrivialUnion); 12335 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12336 } 12337 12338 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12339 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12340 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12341 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12342 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12343 } 12344 12345 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12346 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12347 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12348 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12349 } 12350 12351 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12352 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12353 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12354 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12355 bool IsUnion = false; 12356 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12357 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12358 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12359 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12360 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12361 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12362 } 12363 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12364 } 12365 12366 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12367 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12368 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12369 12370 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12371 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12372 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12373 } 12374 12375 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12376 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12377 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12378 12379 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12380 // non-trivial C union. 12381 QualType OrigTy; 12382 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12383 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12384 Sema &S; 12385 }; 12386 12387 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 12388 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 12389 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 12390 12391 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12392 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12393 Sema &S) 12394 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12395 12396 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12397 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12398 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12399 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12400 InNonTrivialUnion); 12401 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12402 } 12403 12404 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12405 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12406 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12407 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12408 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12409 } 12410 12411 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12412 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12413 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12414 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12415 } 12416 12417 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12418 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12419 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12420 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12421 bool IsUnion = false; 12422 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12423 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12424 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12425 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12426 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12427 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12428 } 12429 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12430 } 12431 12432 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12433 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12434 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12435 12436 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12437 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12438 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12439 } 12440 12441 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12442 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12443 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12444 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12445 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12446 12447 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12448 // non-trivial C union. 12449 QualType OrigTy; 12450 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12451 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12452 Sema &S; 12453 }; 12454 12455 } // namespace 12456 12457 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 12458 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12459 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 12460 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12461 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 12462 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12463 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 12464 12465 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 12466 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12467 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12468 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12469 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 12470 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 12471 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12472 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12473 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12474 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12475 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12476 } 12477 12478 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 12479 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 12480 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 12481 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 12482 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 12483 // the initializer. 12484 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12485 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 12486 return; 12487 } 12488 12489 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12490 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 12491 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 12492 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 12493 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 12494 return; 12495 } 12496 12497 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 12498 if (!VDecl) { 12499 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 12500 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 12501 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12502 return; 12503 } 12504 12505 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 12506 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12507 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 12508 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 12509 // TypoExpr. 12510 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 12511 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 12512 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 12513 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 12514 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12515 return; 12516 } 12517 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 12518 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 12519 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12520 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 12521 return; 12522 } 12523 Init = Res.get(); 12524 12525 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 12526 return; 12527 } 12528 12529 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 12530 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12531 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12532 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12533 return; 12534 } 12535 12536 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12537 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12538 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12539 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12540 return; 12541 } 12542 12543 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12544 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12545 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12546 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12547 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12548 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12549 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12550 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12551 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12552 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12553 return; 12554 } 12555 12556 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12557 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12558 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12559 AbstractVariableType)) 12560 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12561 } 12562 12563 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12564 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12565 // handle the situation. 12566 if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) 12567 if (Def != VDecl && 12568 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12569 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12570 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12571 return; 12572 12573 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12574 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12575 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12576 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12577 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12578 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12579 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12580 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12581 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12582 // 12583 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12584 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12585 // declaration with an initializer. 12586 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12587 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12588 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12589 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12590 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12591 << 0; 12592 return; 12593 } 12594 12595 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12596 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12597 12598 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12599 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12600 return; 12601 } 12602 } 12603 12604 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12605 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12606 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12607 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12608 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12609 return; 12610 } 12611 12612 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12613 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12614 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12615 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12616 return; 12617 } 12618 12619 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12620 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12621 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12622 12623 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12624 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12625 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12626 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12627 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12628 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12629 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12630 return; 12631 } 12632 Init = Result.get(); 12633 } 12634 12635 // Perform the initialization. 12636 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12637 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12638 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12639 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12640 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12641 12642 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12643 if (CXXDirectInit) 12644 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12645 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12646 12647 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12648 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12649 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12650 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12651 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12652 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12653 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12654 }); 12655 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12656 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12657 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12658 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12659 } 12660 } 12661 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12662 return; 12663 12664 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12665 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12666 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12667 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12668 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12669 // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12670 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12671 auto RecoveryExpr = 12672 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12673 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12674 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12675 return; 12676 } 12677 12678 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12679 } 12680 12681 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12682 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12683 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12684 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12685 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12686 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12687 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12688 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12689 12690 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12691 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12692 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12693 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12694 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12695 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12696 12697 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12698 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12699 12700 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12701 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12702 12703 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12704 // Although this code can still have problems: 12705 // id x = self.weakProp; 12706 // id y = self.weakProp; 12707 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12708 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12709 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12710 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12711 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12712 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12713 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12714 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12715 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12716 } 12717 12718 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12719 // 12720 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12721 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12722 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12723 // 12724 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12725 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12726 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12727 // 12728 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12729 ExprResult Result = 12730 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12731 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12732 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12733 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12734 return; 12735 } 12736 Init = Result.get(); 12737 12738 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12739 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12740 12741 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12742 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12743 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12744 // do nothing 12745 12746 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12747 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12748 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12749 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12750 12751 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12752 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12753 // do nothing 12754 12755 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12756 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12757 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12758 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12759 12760 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12761 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12762 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12763 // constant expressions. 12764 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12765 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12766 const Expr *Culprit; 12767 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12768 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12769 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12770 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12771 } 12772 } 12773 12774 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12775 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12776 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12777 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12778 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12779 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12780 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12781 // 12782 // struct S { 12783 // static const int value = 17; 12784 // }; 12785 12786 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12787 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12788 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12789 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12790 // 12791 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12792 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12793 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12794 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12795 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12796 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12797 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12798 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12799 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12800 12801 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12802 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12803 12804 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12805 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12806 // type. 12807 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12808 12809 // Require constness. 12810 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12811 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12812 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12813 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12814 12815 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12816 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12817 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12818 SourceLocation Loc; 12819 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12820 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12821 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12822 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12823 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12824 ; // Nothing to check. 12825 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12826 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12827 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12828 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12829 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12830 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12831 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12832 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12833 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12834 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12835 } else { 12836 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12837 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 12838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12839 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12840 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12841 } 12842 12843 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 12844 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 12845 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 12846 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 12847 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 12848 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 12849 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12850 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12851 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 12852 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12853 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12854 } else { 12855 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 12856 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12857 12858 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12859 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12860 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12861 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12862 } 12863 } 12864 12865 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 12866 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 12867 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 12868 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 12869 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12870 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 12871 12872 } else { 12873 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 12874 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12875 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12876 } 12877 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 12878 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 12879 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 12880 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 12881 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 12882 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 12883 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 12884 // C++ rules. 12885 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 12886 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 12887 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 12888 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 12889 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 12890 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 12891 12892 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 12893 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 12894 // __declspec(dllexport). 12895 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 12896 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 12897 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 12898 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 12899 12900 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 12901 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12902 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12903 } 12904 12905 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12906 if (!InitType.isNull() && 12907 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12908 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 12909 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 12910 12911 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 12912 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 12913 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 12914 // 12915 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 12916 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 12917 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 12918 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 12919 // special case code. 12920 12921 // C++ 8.5p11: 12922 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 12923 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 12924 // class type. 12925 if (CXXDirectInit) { 12926 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 12927 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12928 } else if (DirectInit) { 12929 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 12930 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 12931 } 12932 12933 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && 12934 (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) && 12935 VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 12936 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl); 12937 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 12938 } 12939 12940 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 12941 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish 12942 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or 12943 /// complete. 12944 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 12945 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 12946 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 12947 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12948 12949 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12950 if (!VD) return; 12951 12952 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12953 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 12954 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 12955 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 12956 12957 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12958 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12959 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12960 return; 12961 } 12962 12963 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 12964 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 12965 12966 // Require a complete type. 12967 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 12968 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 12969 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12970 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12971 return; 12972 } 12973 12974 // Require a non-abstract type. 12975 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 12976 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12977 AbstractVariableType)) { 12978 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12979 return; 12980 } 12981 12982 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 12983 // though. 12984 } 12985 12986 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 12987 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 12988 if (!RealDecl) 12989 return; 12990 12991 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12992 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 12993 12994 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 12995 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12996 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 12997 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12998 return; 12999 } 13000 13001 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 13002 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 13003 return; 13004 13005 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 13006 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 13007 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 13008 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 13009 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 13010 // member. 13011 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13012 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 13013 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 13014 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 13015 // a definition there. 13016 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 13017 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 13018 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13019 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 13020 << Var; 13021 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13022 return; 13023 } 13024 } else { 13025 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 13026 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13027 return; 13028 } 13029 } 13030 13031 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 13032 // be initialized. 13033 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13034 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 13035 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 13036 bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false; 13037 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13038 for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) { 13039 if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 && 13040 Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() == 13041 LangAS::opencl_constant) { 13042 HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true; 13043 } 13044 } 13045 } 13046 if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) { 13047 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 13048 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13049 return; 13050 } 13051 } 13052 13053 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 13054 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 13055 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 13056 << Var; 13057 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13058 return; 13059 } 13060 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 13061 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13062 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13063 return; 13064 } 13065 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13066 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 13067 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 13068 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13069 return; 13070 } 13071 } 13072 // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks. 13073 return; 13074 } 13075 13076 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 13077 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 13078 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 13079 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 13080 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 13081 13082 13083 switch (DefKind) { 13084 case VarDecl::Definition: 13085 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 13086 break; 13087 13088 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 13089 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 13090 // a declaration. 13091 // 13092 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 13093 13094 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 13095 // It's only a declaration. 13096 13097 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 13098 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 13099 // object shall be complete. 13100 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 13101 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13102 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13103 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 13104 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13105 13106 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 13107 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13108 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13109 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13110 AbstractVariableType)) 13111 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13112 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13113 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 13114 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 13115 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 13116 } 13117 13118 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() && 13119 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13120 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 13121 13122 return; 13123 13124 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 13125 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 13126 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 13127 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 13128 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 13129 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 13130 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 13131 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 13132 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 13133 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 13134 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 13135 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 13136 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13137 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 13138 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 13139 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 13140 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 13141 // NOTE: code such as the following 13142 // static struct s; 13143 // struct s { int a; }; 13144 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 13145 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 13146 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 13147 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 13148 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13149 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 13150 } 13151 } 13152 13153 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 13154 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13155 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 13156 return; 13157 } 13158 13159 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13160 // definitions with incomplete array type. 13161 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 13162 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13163 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 13164 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13165 return; 13166 } 13167 13168 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13169 // definitions with reference type. 13170 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 13171 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 13172 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 13173 return; 13174 } 13175 13176 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 13177 // variable with dependent type. 13178 if (Type->isDependentType()) 13179 return; 13180 13181 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13182 return; 13183 13184 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 13185 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 13186 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 13187 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13188 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13189 return; 13190 } 13191 } else { 13192 return; 13193 } 13194 13195 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 13196 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13197 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13198 AbstractVariableType)) { 13199 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13200 return; 13201 } 13202 13203 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 13204 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 13205 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 13206 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 13207 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 13208 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 13209 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 13210 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 13211 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 13212 // types and is declared without an initializer. 13213 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13214 if (const RecordType *Record 13215 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13216 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 13217 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 13218 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 13219 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 13220 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 13221 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13222 } 13223 } 13224 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 13225 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 13226 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13227 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 13228 return; 13229 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 13230 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 13231 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 13232 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 13233 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 13234 // type shall have a user-declared default 13235 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 13236 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 13237 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 13238 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 13239 // program is ill-formed. 13240 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 13241 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 13242 // default-initialized; [...]. 13243 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 13244 InitializationKind Kind 13245 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 13246 13247 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13248 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13249 13250 if (Init.get()) { 13251 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 13252 // This is important for template substitution. 13253 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 13254 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 13255 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 13256 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 13257 auto RecoveryExpr = 13258 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 13259 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 13260 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 13261 } 13262 13263 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 13264 } 13265 } 13266 13267 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 13268 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 13269 if (!D) 13270 return; 13271 13272 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 13273 if (!VD) { 13274 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 13275 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13276 return; 13277 } 13278 13279 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13280 13281 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 13282 int Error = -1; 13283 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 13284 case SC_None: 13285 break; 13286 case SC_Extern: 13287 Error = 0; 13288 break; 13289 case SC_Static: 13290 Error = 1; 13291 break; 13292 case SC_PrivateExtern: 13293 Error = 2; 13294 break; 13295 case SC_Auto: 13296 Error = 3; 13297 break; 13298 case SC_Register: 13299 Error = 4; 13300 break; 13301 } 13302 13303 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't. 13304 switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) { 13305 case TSCS_thread_local: 13306 Error = 6; 13307 break; 13308 case TSCS___thread: 13309 case TSCS__Thread_local: 13310 case TSCS_unspecified: 13311 break; 13312 } 13313 13314 if (Error != -1) { 13315 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 13316 << VD << Error; 13317 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13318 } 13319 } 13320 13321 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 13322 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 13323 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 13324 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 13325 // A range-based for statement of the form 13326 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13327 // is equivalent to 13328 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13329 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 13330 13331 const char *PrevSpec; 13332 unsigned DiagID; 13333 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 13334 getPrintingPolicy()); 13335 13336 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::ForInit); 13337 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 13338 D.takeAttributes(Attrs); 13339 13340 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 13341 IdentLoc); 13342 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 13343 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13344 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 13345 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 13346 Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd() 13347 : IdentLoc); 13348 } 13349 13350 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 13351 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13352 13353 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var); 13354 13355 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13356 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 13357 // initialiser 13358 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 13359 !var->hasInit()) { 13360 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 13361 << 1 /*Init*/; 13362 var->setInvalidDecl(); 13363 return; 13364 } 13365 } 13366 13367 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 13368 // local retaining variable. 13369 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 13370 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13371 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 13372 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 13373 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 13374 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 13375 break; 13376 13377 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 13378 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 13379 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13380 break; 13381 } 13382 } 13383 13384 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 13385 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 13386 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13387 13388 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 13389 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 13390 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 13391 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 13392 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 13393 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13394 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 13395 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 13396 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 13397 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 13398 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 13399 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 13400 var->getLocation())) { 13401 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 13402 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 13403 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 13404 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 13405 13406 if (!prev) { 13407 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 13408 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 13409 << /* variable */ 0; 13410 } 13411 } 13412 13413 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 13414 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 13415 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 13416 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 13417 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 13418 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 13419 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 13420 return *CacheHasConstInit; 13421 }; 13422 13423 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 13424 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 13425 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 13426 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 13427 // have a non-trivial destructor. 13428 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 13429 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13430 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13431 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 13432 if (!checkConstInit()) { 13433 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 13434 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 13435 // initialization. 13436 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 13437 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 13438 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13439 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13440 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13441 } 13442 } 13443 } 13444 13445 13446 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 13447 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 13448 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 13449 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 13450 if (NumInits > 2) 13451 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 13452 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 13453 if (!Init) 13454 break; 13455 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13456 if (!SL) 13457 break; 13458 13459 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 13460 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 13461 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 13462 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 13463 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 13464 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 13465 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 13466 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 13467 if (!Init) 13468 break; 13469 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13470 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 13471 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 13472 break; 13473 } 13474 } 13475 13476 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 13477 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 13478 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 13479 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 13480 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 13481 13482 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 13483 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 13484 << Hints; 13485 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 13486 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 13487 } 13488 // In any case, stop now. 13489 break; 13490 } 13491 } 13492 } 13493 13494 13495 QualType type = var->getType(); 13496 13497 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 13498 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 13499 13500 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 13501 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 13502 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 13503 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 13504 bool HasConstInit = true; 13505 13506 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 13507 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init && 13508 !Init->isValueDependent() && 13509 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 13510 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 13511 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 13512 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 13513 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 13514 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 13515 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13516 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13517 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13518 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13519 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13520 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13521 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13522 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13523 13524 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13525 // constant initializer. 13526 if (HasConstInit) { 13527 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13528 Notes.clear(); 13529 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13530 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13531 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13532 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13533 } 13534 } else { 13535 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13536 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13537 } 13538 13539 if (HasConstInit) { 13540 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13541 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13542 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13543 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13544 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13545 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13546 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13547 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13548 Notes.clear(); 13549 } 13550 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13551 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13552 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13553 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13554 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13555 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13556 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13557 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13558 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13559 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13560 for (auto &it : Notes) 13561 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13562 } else if (IsGlobal && 13563 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13564 var->getLocation())) { 13565 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13566 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13567 // warned about them. 13568 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13569 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13570 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13571 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13572 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13573 if (!checkConstInit()) 13574 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13575 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13576 } 13577 } 13578 } 13579 13580 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 13581 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13582 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 13583 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 13584 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 13585 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) { 13586 if (HasConstInit) 13587 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 13588 else { 13589 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13590 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13591 } 13592 } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) { 13593 Stack = &DataSegStack; 13594 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13595 } else { 13596 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13597 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13598 } 13599 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13600 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 13601 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13602 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 13603 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 13604 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13605 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 13606 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13607 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 13608 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 13609 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 13610 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 13611 } 13612 13613 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 13614 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 13615 // attribute. 13616 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 13617 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 13618 CurInitSegLoc, 13619 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13620 } 13621 13622 // All the following checks are C++ only. 13623 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13624 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 13625 // current module. 13626 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13627 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13628 return; 13629 } 13630 13631 // Require the destructor. 13632 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13633 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13634 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13635 13636 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13637 // module. 13638 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13639 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13640 13641 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13642 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13643 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13644 } 13645 13646 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13647 /// dllexport/import function. 13648 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13649 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13650 13651 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13652 13653 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13654 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13655 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13656 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13657 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13658 } 13659 13660 if (!FD) 13661 return; 13662 13663 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13664 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13665 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13666 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13667 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13668 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13669 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13670 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13671 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13672 13673 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13674 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13675 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13676 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13677 13678 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13679 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13680 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13681 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13682 } 13683 } 13684 13685 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13686 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13687 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13688 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13689 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13690 13691 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13692 if (!VD) 13693 return; 13694 13695 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13696 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13697 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13698 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13699 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13700 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13701 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13702 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13703 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13704 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13705 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13706 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13707 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13708 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13709 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13710 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13711 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13712 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13713 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13714 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13715 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13716 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13717 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13718 } 13719 13720 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13721 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13722 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13723 } 13724 } 13725 13726 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13727 13728 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13729 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13730 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13731 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13732 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13733 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13734 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) { 13735 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13736 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13737 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13738 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13739 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13740 } 13741 } 13742 } 13743 13744 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13745 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13746 13747 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13748 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13749 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13750 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13751 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13752 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13753 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13754 13755 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13756 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13757 13758 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13759 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13760 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13761 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13762 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13763 // with a warning. 13764 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13765 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13766 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13767 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13768 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13769 13770 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13771 IsClassTemplateMember 13772 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13773 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13774 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13775 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13776 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13777 } 13778 } 13779 13780 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13781 // isn't exported with the variable. 13782 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13783 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13784 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13785 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13786 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13787 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13788 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13789 } else { 13790 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13791 << DLLAttr; 13792 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13793 } 13794 } 13795 13796 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13797 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13798 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13799 << Attr; 13800 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13801 } 13802 } 13803 if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 13804 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13805 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13806 << Attr; 13807 VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>(); 13808 } 13809 } 13810 13811 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13812 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13813 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13814 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13815 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13816 13817 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13818 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13819 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13820 13821 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13822 // tag values. 13823 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13824 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13825 return; 13826 13827 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13828 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13829 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13830 continue; 13831 } 13832 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13833 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13834 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13835 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13836 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13837 continue; 13838 } 13839 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 13840 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13841 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 13842 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13843 continue; 13844 } 13845 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 13846 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 13847 MagicValue, 13848 I->getMatchingCType(), 13849 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 13850 I->getMustBeNull()); 13851 } 13852 } 13853 13854 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 13855 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 13856 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 13857 } 13858 13859 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 13860 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13861 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 13862 13863 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 13864 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 13865 13866 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13867 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13868 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 13869 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 13870 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 13871 13872 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13873 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 13874 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 13875 // to perform. 13876 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 13877 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 13878 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 13879 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 13880 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 13881 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 13882 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 13883 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 13884 13885 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 13886 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 13887 // declaration in the same group. 13888 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 13889 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 13890 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 13891 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13892 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13893 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 13894 } 13895 13896 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 13897 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 13898 // declarator in the same group. 13899 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 13900 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 13901 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 13902 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 13903 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 13904 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13905 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13906 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 13907 } 13908 } 13909 } 13910 13911 Decls.push_back(D); 13912 } 13913 } 13914 13915 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 13916 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 13917 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 13918 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 13919 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13920 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 13921 } 13922 } 13923 13924 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 13925 } 13926 13927 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 13928 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 13929 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 13930 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13931 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 13932 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 13933 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 13934 if (Group.size() > 1) { 13935 QualType Deduced; 13936 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 13937 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13938 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 13939 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 13940 break; 13941 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 13942 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 13943 continue; 13944 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 13945 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 13946 DeducedDecl = D; 13947 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 13948 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 13949 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13950 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 13951 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 13952 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 13953 << D->getDeclName(); 13954 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 13955 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13956 if (D->getInit()) 13957 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13958 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13959 break; 13960 } 13961 } 13962 } 13963 13964 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 13965 13966 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 13967 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 13968 } 13969 13970 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 13971 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 13972 } 13973 13974 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13975 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 13976 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 13977 return; 13978 13979 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 13980 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 13981 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 13982 Group[0]->getLocation())) 13983 return; 13984 13985 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 13986 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 13987 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 13988 // additional declaration references: 13989 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 13990 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 13991 // 'struct S *pS;' 13992 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 13993 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 13994 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 13995 Group = Group.slice(1); 13996 } 13997 } 13998 13999 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 14000 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 14001 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 14002 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 14003 } 14004 14005 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 14006 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 14007 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14008 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 14009 // parameter. 14010 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14011 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 14012 14013 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 14014 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 14015 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 14016 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 14017 } 14018 14019 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 14020 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 14021 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 14022 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 14023 break; 14024 14025 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 14026 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 14027 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 14028 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 14029 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 14030 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 14031 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 14032 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 14033 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 14034 break; 14035 14036 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 14037 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 14038 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 14039 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 14040 break; 14041 } 14042 } 14043 14044 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 14045 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 14046 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14047 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 14048 14049 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 14050 14051 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 14052 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 14053 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 14054 SC = SC_Register; 14055 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 14056 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 14057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14058 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14059 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 14060 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 14061 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 14062 } 14063 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14064 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 14065 SC = SC_Auto; 14066 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 14067 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14068 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 14069 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 14070 } 14071 14072 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 14073 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 14074 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 14075 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 14076 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 14077 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 14078 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14079 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 14080 << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 14081 14082 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 14083 14084 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 14085 14086 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 14087 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 14088 14089 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 14090 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 14091 if (II) { 14092 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 14093 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 14094 LookupName(R, S); 14095 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 14096 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 14097 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 14098 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 14099 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 14100 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 14101 PrevDecl = nullptr; 14102 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 14103 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 14104 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14105 14106 // Recover by removing the name 14107 II = nullptr; 14108 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 14109 D.setInvalidType(true); 14110 } 14111 } 14112 } 14113 14114 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 14115 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 14116 // looking like class members in C++. 14117 ParmVarDecl *New = 14118 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 14119 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 14120 14121 if (D.isInvalidType()) 14122 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14123 14124 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 14125 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 14126 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 14127 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 14128 14129 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 14130 S->AddDecl(New); 14131 if (II) 14132 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 14133 14134 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 14135 14136 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 14137 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 14138 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 14139 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 14140 14141 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 14142 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 14143 } 14144 14145 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14146 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 14147 14148 return New; 14149 } 14150 14151 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 14152 /// typedef. 14153 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 14154 SourceLocation Loc, 14155 QualType T) { 14156 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 14157 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 14158 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 14159 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 14160 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 14161 SC_None, nullptr); 14162 Param->setImplicit(); 14163 return Param; 14164 } 14165 14166 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 14167 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 14168 // will already have done so in the template itself. 14169 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 14170 return; 14171 14172 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14173 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 14174 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 14175 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 14176 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 14177 } 14178 } 14179 } 14180 14181 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 14182 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 14183 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 14184 return; 14185 14186 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14187 // threshold. 14188 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 14189 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 14190 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14191 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 14192 } 14193 14194 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14195 // threshold. 14196 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14197 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 14198 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 14199 continue; 14200 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 14201 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14202 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 14203 << Parameter << Size; 14204 } 14205 } 14206 14207 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 14208 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 14209 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 14210 StorageClass SC) { 14211 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 14212 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 14213 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 14214 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 14215 14216 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 14217 14218 // Special cases for arrays: 14219 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 14220 // - otherwise, it's an error 14221 if (T->isArrayType()) { 14222 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 14223 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 14224 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 14225 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 14226 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 14227 else 14228 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 14229 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14230 } 14231 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 14232 } else { 14233 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 14234 } 14235 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 14236 } 14237 14238 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 14239 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 14240 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 14241 14242 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 14243 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 14244 // lambda scope. 14245 if (New->isParameterPack()) 14246 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 14247 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 14248 14249 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 14250 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 14251 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 14252 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 14253 14254 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 14255 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 14256 // the class has been completely parsed. 14257 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 14258 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 14259 AbstractParamType)) 14260 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14261 14262 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 14263 // passed by reference. 14264 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 14265 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 14266 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 14267 Diag(NameLoc, 14268 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 14269 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 14270 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 14271 New->setType(T); 14272 } 14273 14274 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 14275 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 14276 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 14277 // an address space. 14278 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 14279 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 14280 // to be qualified with an address space. 14281 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 14282 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 14283 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 14284 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14285 } 14286 14287 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 14288 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 14289 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 14290 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14291 } 14292 14293 return New; 14294 } 14295 14296 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 14297 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 14298 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 14299 14300 // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration 14301 // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those 14302 // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and 14303 // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared. 14304 // 14305 // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the 14306 // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list." 14307 // 14308 // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions 14309 // listed are checked elsewhere. 14310 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 14311 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 14312 --i; 14313 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 14314 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 14315 SmallString<256> Code; 14316 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 14317 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 14318 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 14319 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 14320 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 14321 } 14322 14323 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 14324 // type. 14325 AttributeFactory attrs; 14326 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 14327 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 14328 unsigned DiagID; // unused 14329 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 14330 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14331 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 14332 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14333 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14334 Declarator ParamD(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), 14335 DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList); 14336 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14337 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 14338 } 14339 } 14340 } 14341 } 14342 14343 Decl * 14344 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 14345 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 14346 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14347 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 14348 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 14349 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 14350 14351 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 14352 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 14353 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 14354 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 14355 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 14356 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 14357 // `omp begin declare variant`. 14358 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 14359 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 14360 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 14361 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 14362 14363 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition); 14364 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 14365 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind); 14366 14367 if (!Bases.empty()) 14368 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 14369 14370 return Dcl; 14371 } 14372 14373 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 14374 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 14375 } 14376 14377 static bool 14378 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 14379 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 14380 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 14381 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14382 return false; 14383 14384 // Or declarations that aren't global. 14385 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 14386 return false; 14387 14388 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 14389 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 14390 return false; 14391 14392 // Don't warn about 'main'. 14393 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 14394 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 14395 if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main")) 14396 return false; 14397 14398 // Don't warn about inline functions. 14399 if (FD->isInlined()) 14400 return false; 14401 14402 // Don't warn about function templates. 14403 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14404 return false; 14405 14406 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 14407 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 14408 return false; 14409 14410 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 14411 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 14412 return false; 14413 14414 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 14415 if (FD->isDeleted()) 14416 return false; 14417 14418 // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed 14419 // parameters). 14420 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 14421 return false; 14422 14423 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 14424 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 14425 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 14426 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 14427 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14428 continue; 14429 14430 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 14431 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 14432 } 14433 14434 return true; 14435 } 14436 14437 void 14438 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 14439 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 14440 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14441 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 14442 if (!Definition && 14443 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 14444 return; 14445 14446 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 14447 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14448 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14449 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 14450 // the same class, is OK. 14451 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 14452 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 14453 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 14454 return; 14455 } 14456 } 14457 } 14458 14459 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 14460 return; 14461 14462 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 14463 // definition. 14464 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 14465 return; 14466 14467 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 14468 // a template, skip the new definition. 14469 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 14470 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 14471 Definition->isInlined() || 14472 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 14473 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 14474 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 14475 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 14476 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14477 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 14478 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 14479 return; 14480 } 14481 14482 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 14483 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 14484 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 14485 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 14486 else 14487 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 14488 14489 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 14490 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14491 } 14492 14493 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 14494 Sema &S) { 14495 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 14496 14497 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 14498 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 14499 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 14500 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 14501 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 14502 14503 if (LCD == LCD_None) 14504 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 14505 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 14506 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 14507 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 14508 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 14509 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 14510 14511 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 14512 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 14513 14514 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 14515 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 14516 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 14517 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 14518 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 14519 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 14520 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 14521 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 14522 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 14523 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 14524 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 14525 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 14526 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 14527 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 14528 14529 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 14530 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 14531 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 14532 } else { 14533 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 14534 I->getType()); 14535 } 14536 ++I; 14537 } 14538 } 14539 14540 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 14541 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, 14542 FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14543 if (!D) { 14544 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 14545 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 14546 PushFunctionScope(); 14547 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14548 return D; 14549 } 14550 14551 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 14552 14553 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14554 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 14555 else 14556 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 14557 14558 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 14559 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 14560 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 14561 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14562 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 14563 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14564 14565 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 14566 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 14567 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 14568 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 14569 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14570 } 14571 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 14572 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 14573 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 14574 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14575 } 14576 14577 if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) { 14578 if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 14579 Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() && 14580 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 14581 // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any 14582 // default arguments. 14583 InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor); 14584 } 14585 } 14586 14587 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 14588 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 14589 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14590 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14591 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14592 14593 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14594 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14595 return D; 14596 } 14597 14598 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14599 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14600 // this function. 14601 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14602 14603 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14604 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14605 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14606 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14607 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14608 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14609 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14610 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14611 // have the LSI properly restored. 14612 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14613 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14614 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14615 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14616 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14617 } else { 14618 // Enter a new function scope 14619 PushFunctionScope(); 14620 } 14621 14622 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14623 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14624 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14625 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14626 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14627 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14628 } 14629 } 14630 14631 // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3), 14632 // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2) 14633 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14634 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14635 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete && 14636 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14637 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14638 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14639 14640 if (FnBodyScope) 14641 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14642 14643 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14644 if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete) 14645 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14646 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14647 14648 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14649 // scope. 14650 if (FnBodyScope) { 14651 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14652 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14653 if (!NonParmDecl) 14654 continue; 14655 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14656 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14657 14658 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14659 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14660 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14661 14662 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14663 // accessible in this scope. 14664 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14665 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14666 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14667 } 14668 } 14669 } 14670 14671 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14672 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14673 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14674 14675 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14676 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14677 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14678 14679 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14680 } 14681 } 14682 14683 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14684 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14685 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14686 14687 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14688 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14689 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14690 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14691 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14692 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14693 return D; 14694 } 14695 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14696 // a function template). 14697 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14698 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14699 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14700 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14701 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14702 14703 return D; 14704 } 14705 14706 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14707 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14708 /// optimization. 14709 /// 14710 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14711 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14712 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14713 /// use the named return value optimization. 14714 /// 14715 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14716 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14717 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14718 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14719 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14720 14721 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14722 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14723 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14724 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14725 } 14726 } 14727 } 14728 14729 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14730 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14731 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14732 return false; 14733 14734 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14735 // return type (yet). 14736 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14737 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14738 // we can still delay parsing it. 14739 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14740 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14741 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14742 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14743 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14744 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14745 } 14746 } 14747 return false; 14748 } 14749 14750 return true; 14751 } 14752 14753 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14754 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14755 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14756 // rest of the file. 14757 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14758 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14759 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14760 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14761 return false; 14762 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14763 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14764 // "undeduced". 14765 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14766 return false; 14767 } 14768 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14769 } 14770 14771 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14772 if (!Decl) 14773 return nullptr; 14774 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14775 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14776 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14777 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14778 return Decl; 14779 } 14780 14781 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14782 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14783 } 14784 14785 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14786 /// body. 14787 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14788 public: 14789 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14790 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14791 if (!IsLambda) 14792 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14793 } 14794 14795 private: 14796 Sema &S; 14797 bool IsLambda = false; 14798 }; 14799 14800 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14801 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14802 14803 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14804 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14805 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14806 14807 bool R = false; 14808 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14809 14810 do { 14811 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14812 if (R) 14813 break; 14814 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14815 } while (CurBD); 14816 14817 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14818 }; 14819 14820 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14821 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14822 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14823 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14824 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14825 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14826 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14827 } 14828 14829 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14830 bool IsInstantiation) { 14831 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14832 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14833 14834 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14835 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14836 14837 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14838 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 14839 14840 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 14841 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 14842 14843 { 14844 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because 14845 // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). 14846 // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 14847 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 14848 14849 if (FD) { 14850 FD->setBody(Body); 14851 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 14852 14853 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 14854 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 14855 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 14856 // For a function with a deduced result type to return void, 14857 // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)', 14858 // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified. 14859 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 14860 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 14861 << FD->getReturnType(); 14862 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14863 } else { 14864 // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'. 14865 Expr *Dummy = nullptr; 14866 if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr( 14867 FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy, 14868 FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>())) 14869 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14870 } 14871 } 14872 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 14873 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 14874 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 14875 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 14876 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 14877 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 14878 14879 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 14880 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 14881 // [the deduced type is] the type void 14882 QualType RetType = 14883 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 14884 14885 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 14886 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14887 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 14888 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 14889 } 14890 } 14891 14892 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 14893 // don't complain about missing return statements. 14894 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14895 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 14896 14897 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 14898 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 14899 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 14900 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 14901 14902 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14903 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked 14904 // functions. 14905 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() && 14906 !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14907 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 14908 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 14909 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 14910 14911 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 14912 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 14913 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 14914 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 14915 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 14916 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 14917 14918 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 14919 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 14920 // to deduce an implicit return type. 14921 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 14922 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 14923 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14924 } 14925 14926 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 14927 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 14928 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 14929 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 14930 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 14931 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 14932 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 14933 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 14934 14935 if (PossiblePrototype) { 14936 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 14937 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 14938 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 14939 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14940 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 14941 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 14942 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 14943 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 14944 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 14945 FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 14946 : FixItHint{}); 14947 } 14948 } else { 14949 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 14950 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 14951 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 14952 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 14953 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 14954 return false; 14955 14956 bool Invalid = false; 14957 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 14958 if (Invalid) 14959 return false; 14960 14961 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 14962 return false; 14963 14964 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 14965 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 14966 14967 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 14968 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 14969 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 14970 }; 14971 14972 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 14973 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 14974 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 14975 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 14976 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 14977 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 14978 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 14979 14980 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 14981 getLangOpts())) 14982 14983 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 14984 } 14985 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 14986 }; 14987 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), 14988 diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 14989 << /* function */ 1 14990 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 14991 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 14992 : FixItHint{}); 14993 } 14994 } 14995 14996 // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may 14997 // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know 14998 // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the 14999 // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters 15000 // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous 15001 // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases 15002 // like: 15003 // void f(); void f(a) int a; {} 15004 // void g(a) int a; {} 15005 // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change 15006 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 15007 // type without a prototype. 15008 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 && 15009 (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() && 15010 !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) { 15011 // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior 15012 // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the 15013 // function definition. 15014 // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being 15015 // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but 15016 // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in 15017 // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do 15018 // this awkward dance instead. 15019 // 15020 // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a 15021 // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible 15022 // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been 15023 // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether 15024 // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being 15025 // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't 15026 // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not 15027 // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior. 15028 15029 // This K&R C function definition definitely changes behavior in C2x, 15030 // so diagnose it. 15031 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15032 << /*definition*/ 1 << /* not supported in C2x */ 0; 15033 15034 // If we have a possible prototype for the function which is a user- 15035 // visible declaration, we already tested that it has no prototype. 15036 // This will change behavior in C2x. This gets a warning rather than a 15037 // note because it's the same behavior-changing problem as with the 15038 // definition. 15039 if (PossiblePrototype) 15040 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 15041 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15042 << /*declaration*/ 0 << /* conflicting */ 1 << /*subsequent*/ 1 15043 << /*definition*/ 1; 15044 } 15045 15046 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 15047 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 15048 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 15049 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 15050 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 15051 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 15052 15053 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 15054 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 15055 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 15056 MD->isVirtual() && 15057 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 15058 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 15059 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 15060 if (FD->isInlined() && 15061 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 15062 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 15063 15064 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 15065 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 15066 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 15067 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 15068 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 15069 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15070 } else { 15071 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 15072 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15073 } 15074 } 15075 } 15076 15077 assert( 15078 (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 15079 "Function parsing confused"); 15080 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 15081 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 15082 MD->setBody(Body); 15083 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 15084 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 15085 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 15086 15087 if (Body) 15088 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 15089 } 15090 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 15091 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 15092 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 15093 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 15094 } 15095 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 15096 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 15097 bool isDesignated = 15098 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 15099 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 15100 (void)isDesignated; 15101 15102 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 15103 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 15104 if (!IFace) 15105 return false; 15106 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 15107 if (!SuperD) 15108 return false; 15109 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 15110 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 15111 }; 15112 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 15113 // of NSObject. 15114 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 15115 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15116 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 15117 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 15118 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 15119 } 15120 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 15121 } 15122 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 15123 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 15124 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 15125 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15126 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 15127 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 15128 } 15129 15130 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 15131 } else { 15132 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 15133 // we pushed on. 15134 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15135 return nullptr; 15136 } 15137 15138 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 15139 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 15140 15141 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 15142 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 15143 "handled in the block above."); 15144 15145 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 15146 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 15147 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 15148 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 15149 // Verify this. 15150 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 15151 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 15152 15153 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 15154 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 15155 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 15156 15157 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 15158 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 15159 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 15160 15161 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 15162 Destructor->getParent()); 15163 } 15164 15165 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15166 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up 15167 // for deletion in some later function. 15168 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 15169 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 15170 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15171 } 15172 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 15173 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 15174 // enabled. 15175 ActivePolicy = &WP; 15176 } 15177 15178 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 15179 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 15180 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15181 15182 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 15183 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 15184 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 15185 // require prologue. 15186 bool RegisterVariables = false; 15187 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 15188 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 15189 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 15190 RegisterVariables = 15191 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 15192 if (!RegisterVariables) 15193 break; 15194 } 15195 } 15196 } 15197 if (RegisterVariables) 15198 continue; 15199 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 15200 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 15201 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 15202 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15203 break; 15204 } 15205 } 15206 } 15207 15208 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 15209 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 15210 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 15211 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 15212 "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 15213 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 15214 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 15215 } 15216 } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop 15217 // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform 15218 // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions. 15219 15220 if (!IsInstantiation) 15221 PopDeclContext(); 15222 15223 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15224 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15225 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 15226 // deletion in some later function. 15227 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 15228 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15229 } 15230 15231 if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || 15232 !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) || 15233 LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) { 15234 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 15235 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 15236 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 15237 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD); 15238 } 15239 15240 if (FD && !FD->isDeleted()) 15241 checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD); 15242 15243 return dcl; 15244 } 15245 15246 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 15247 /// relevant Decl. 15248 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 15249 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 15250 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 15251 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 15252 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 15253 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 15254 15255 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 15256 if (Method->isStatic()) 15257 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 15258 } 15259 15260 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 15261 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 15262 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 15263 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 15264 // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x. 15265 assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() && 15266 "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode"); 15267 15268 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 15269 // DeclContext. 15270 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 15271 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 15272 // instead. 15273 Scope *BlockScope = S; 15274 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 15275 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 15276 15277 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 15278 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 15279 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 15280 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 15281 15282 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 15283 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 15284 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 15285 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 15286 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 15287 if (ExternCPrev) { 15288 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 15289 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 15290 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 15291 15292 // C89 footnote 38: 15293 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 15294 // the behavior is undefined. 15295 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 15296 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 15297 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 15298 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 15299 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 15300 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 15301 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15302 return ExternCPrev; 15303 } 15304 } 15305 15306 // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it. 15307 unsigned diag_id; 15308 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 15309 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 15310 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 15311 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 15312 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99; 15313 else 15314 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 15315 15316 TypoCorrection Corrected; 15317 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 15318 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 15319 // 15320 // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers 15321 // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic. 15322 if (S && !ExternCPrev && 15323 (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) { 15324 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 15325 Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 15326 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError); 15327 } 15328 15329 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 15330 if (Corrected) { 15331 // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function, 15332 // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea. 15333 bool Diagnose = true; 15334 if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) 15335 Diagnose = !D->isImplicit(); 15336 if (Diagnose) 15337 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 15338 /*ErrorRecovery*/ false); 15339 } 15340 15341 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 15342 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 15343 // more to do. 15344 if (ExternCPrev) 15345 return ExternCPrev; 15346 15347 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 15348 const char *Dummy; 15349 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 15350 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 15351 unsigned DiagID; 15352 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 15353 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 15354 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 15355 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 15356 SourceLocation NoLoc; 15357 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Block); 15358 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 15359 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 15360 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15361 /*Params=*/nullptr, 15362 /*NumParams=*/0, 15363 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 15364 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15365 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 15366 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 15367 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 15368 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 15369 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 15370 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 15371 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 15372 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 15373 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 15374 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 15375 Loc, D), 15376 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 15377 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 15378 15379 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 15380 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 15381 FD->setImplicit(); 15382 15383 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 15384 15385 return FD; 15386 } 15387 15388 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 15389 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 15390 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 15391 /// 15392 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15393 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15394 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 15395 FunctionDecl *FD) { 15396 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15397 return; 15398 15399 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 15400 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 15401 return; 15402 15403 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 15404 bool IsNothrow = false; 15405 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 15406 return; 15407 15408 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 15409 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 15410 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 15411 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 15412 // throwing an exception [...] 15413 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 15414 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15415 15416 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15417 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15418 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 15419 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 15420 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 15421 // 15422 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 15423 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 15424 15425 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15426 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15427 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 15428 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 15429 // requested size. 15430 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 15431 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15432 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 15433 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15434 } 15435 15436 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15437 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15438 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15439 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 15440 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 15441 // specified by the value of this argument. 15442 if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 15443 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 15444 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 15445 } 15446 15447 // FIXME: 15448 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15449 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15450 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15451 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 15452 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 15453 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 15454 // requested size. 15455 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 15456 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 15457 } 15458 15459 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 15460 /// the declaration of this function. 15461 /// 15462 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 15463 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 15464 /// like NSLog or printf. 15465 /// 15466 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15467 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15468 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 15469 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15470 return; 15471 15472 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 15473 // actual attributes. 15474 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 15475 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 15476 unsigned FormatIdx; 15477 bool HasVAListArg; 15478 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 15479 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 15480 const char *fmt = "printf"; 15481 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 15482 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 15483 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 15484 fmt = "NSString"; 15485 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15486 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 15487 FormatIdx+1, 15488 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15489 FD->getLocation())); 15490 } 15491 } 15492 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 15493 HasVAListArg)) { 15494 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15495 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15496 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 15497 FormatIdx+1, 15498 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15499 FD->getLocation())); 15500 } 15501 15502 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 15503 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 15504 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 15505 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 15506 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 15507 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 15508 15509 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 15510 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 15511 // intrinsics for such functions. 15512 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 15513 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 15514 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15515 15516 // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set 15517 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 15518 // C standard. 15519 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 15520 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 15521 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 15522 switch (BuiltinID) { 15523 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 15524 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 15525 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 15526 case Builtin::BIfma: 15527 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 15528 case Builtin::BIfmal: 15529 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15530 break; 15531 default: 15532 break; 15533 } 15534 } 15535 15536 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 15537 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 15538 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15539 FD->getLocation())); 15540 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 15541 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15542 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 15543 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15544 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 15545 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15546 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 15547 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 15548 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 15549 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 15550 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 15551 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 15552 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 15553 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15554 else 15555 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15556 } 15557 15558 // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions. 15559 switch (BuiltinID) { 15560 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15561 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15562 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) 15563 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15564 FD->getLocation())); 15565 break; 15566 default: 15567 break; 15568 } 15569 15570 // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions. 15571 switch (BuiltinID) { 15572 case Builtin::BIcalloc: 15573 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15574 Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation())); 15575 break; 15576 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15577 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15578 case Builtin::BIrealloc: 15579 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD), 15580 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15581 break; 15582 case Builtin::BImalloc: 15583 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15584 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15585 break; 15586 default: 15587 break; 15588 } 15589 } 15590 15591 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 15592 15593 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 15594 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 15595 // across. 15596 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 15597 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 15598 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15599 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 15600 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15601 } 15602 15603 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 15604 if (!Name) 15605 return; 15606 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15607 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 15608 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 15609 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 15610 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 15611 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 15612 // about. 15613 } else 15614 return; 15615 15616 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 15617 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 15618 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 15619 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15620 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15621 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 15622 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 15623 FD->getLocation())); 15624 } 15625 15626 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 15627 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 15628 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 15629 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 15630 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15631 FD->getLocation())); 15632 } 15633 } 15634 15635 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 15636 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 15637 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 15638 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 15639 15640 if (!TInfo) { 15641 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 15642 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 15643 } 15644 15645 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 15646 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 15647 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 15648 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 15649 15650 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 15651 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 15652 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 15653 return NewTD; 15654 } 15655 15656 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 15657 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15658 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 15659 << 2 << NewTD 15660 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 15661 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 15662 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 15663 else 15664 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 15665 } 15666 15667 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 15668 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 15669 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 15670 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 15671 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 15672 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 15673 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 15674 case TST_enum: 15675 case TST_struct: 15676 case TST_interface: 15677 case TST_union: 15678 case TST_class: { 15679 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 15680 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 15681 break; 15682 } 15683 15684 default: 15685 break; 15686 } 15687 15688 return NewTD; 15689 } 15690 15691 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15692 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15693 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15694 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15695 15696 if (T->isDependentType()) 15697 return false; 15698 15699 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15700 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15701 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15702 if (BT->isInteger()) 15703 return false; 15704 15705 if (T->isBitIntType()) 15706 return false; 15707 15708 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15709 } 15710 15711 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15712 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15713 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15714 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15715 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15716 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15717 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15718 << Prev->isScoped(); 15719 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15720 return true; 15721 } 15722 15723 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15724 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15725 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15726 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15727 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15728 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15729 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15730 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15731 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15732 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15733 return true; 15734 } 15735 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15736 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15737 << Prev->isFixed(); 15738 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15739 return true; 15740 } 15741 15742 return false; 15743 } 15744 15745 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15746 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15747 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15748 /// 15749 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15750 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15751 switch (Tag) { 15752 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15753 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15754 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15755 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15756 } 15757 } 15758 15759 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15760 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15761 /// 15762 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15763 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15764 { 15765 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15766 } 15767 15768 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15769 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15770 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15771 return NTK_Typedef; 15772 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15773 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15774 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15775 return NTK_Template; 15776 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15777 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15778 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15779 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15780 switch (TTK) { 15781 case TTK_Struct: 15782 case TTK_Interface: 15783 case TTK_Class: 15784 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15785 case TTK_Union: 15786 return NTK_NonUnion; 15787 case TTK_Enum: 15788 return NTK_NonEnum; 15789 } 15790 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15791 } 15792 15793 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15794 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15795 /// 15796 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15797 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15798 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15799 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15800 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15801 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15802 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15803 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15804 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15805 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15806 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15807 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15808 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15809 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15810 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15811 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15812 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15813 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15814 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15815 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15816 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15817 return false; 15818 15819 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15820 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15821 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15822 return true; 15823 15824 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15825 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15826 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15827 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15828 // declarations. 15829 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15830 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15831 Loc); 15832 }; 15833 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15834 return true; 15835 15836 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15837 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 15838 }; 15839 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 15840 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 15841 if (!Previous) 15842 return true; 15843 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15844 } 15845 15846 bool isTemplate = false; 15847 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 15848 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 15849 15850 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 15851 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 15852 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 15853 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 15854 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15855 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15856 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15857 // FIXME: Note previous location? 15858 } 15859 return true; 15860 } 15861 15862 if (isDefinition) { 15863 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 15864 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 15865 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 15866 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 15867 return true; 15868 } 15869 15870 bool previousMismatch = false; 15871 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 15872 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15873 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 15874 if (IsIgnored(I)) 15875 continue; 15876 15877 if (!previousMismatch) { 15878 previousMismatch = true; 15879 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 15880 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15881 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 15882 } 15883 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15884 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 15885 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 15886 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 15887 } 15888 } 15889 return true; 15890 } 15891 15892 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 15893 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 15894 // (non-ignored) declaration. 15895 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 15896 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 15897 PrevDef = nullptr; 15898 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 15899 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15900 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15901 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15902 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15903 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15904 15905 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 15906 if (PrevDef) { 15907 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15908 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 15909 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 15910 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 15911 } 15912 } 15913 15914 return true; 15915 } 15916 15917 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 15918 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 15919 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 15920 /// namespace N { 15921 /// struct X; 15922 /// namespace M { 15923 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 15924 /// } 15925 /// } 15926 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 15927 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 15928 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 15929 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 15930 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 15931 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 15932 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15933 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 15934 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 15935 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 15936 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 15937 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 15938 return FixItHint(); 15939 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 15940 Namespaces.push_back(II); 15941 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 15942 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 15943 if (Lookup == Namespace) 15944 break; 15945 } 15946 15947 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 15948 // build an NNS. 15949 SmallString<64> Insertion; 15950 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 15951 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 15952 OS << "::"; 15953 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 15954 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 15955 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 15956 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 15957 } 15958 15959 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 15960 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 15961 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 15962 /// using-declaration). 15963 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 15964 DeclContext *NewDC) { 15965 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 15966 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 15967 15968 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 15969 return true; 15970 15971 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 15972 // encloses the other). 15973 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 15974 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 15975 return true; 15976 15977 return false; 15978 } 15979 15980 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 15981 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 15982 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 15983 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 15984 /// 15985 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 15986 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 15987 /// 15988 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 15989 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 15990 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 15991 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 15992 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 15993 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 15994 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 15995 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 15996 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 15997 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 15998 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 15999 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 16000 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 16001 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 16002 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 16003 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 16004 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 16005 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 16006 16007 OwnedDecl = false; 16008 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 16009 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 16010 16011 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 16012 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 16013 bool Invalid = false; 16014 16015 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 16016 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 16017 // for non-C++ cases. 16018 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 16019 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 16020 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 16021 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 16022 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 16023 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 16024 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16025 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 16026 return nullptr; 16027 } 16028 16029 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 16030 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 16031 // be a member of another template). 16032 16033 if (Invalid) 16034 return nullptr; 16035 16036 OwnedDecl = false; 16037 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 16038 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 16039 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 16040 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 16041 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 16042 return Result.get(); 16043 } else { 16044 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 16045 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 16046 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 16047 isMemberSpecialization = true; 16048 } 16049 } 16050 16051 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 16052 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 16053 return nullptr; 16054 } 16055 16056 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 16057 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 16058 // redeclaration. 16059 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 16060 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 16061 16062 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16063 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 16064 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 16065 // type, default to int. 16066 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16067 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 16068 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 16069 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 16070 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 16071 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 16072 EnumUnderlying = TI; 16073 16074 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 16075 // Recover by falling back to int. 16076 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16077 16078 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 16079 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 16080 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16081 16082 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 16083 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 16084 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 16085 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 16086 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 16087 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16088 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16089 } 16090 } 16091 16092 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 16093 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 16094 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 16095 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 16096 16097 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 16098 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 16099 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 16100 16101 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 16102 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 16103 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 16104 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 16105 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 16106 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16107 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16108 // keyword. 16109 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16110 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 16111 16112 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16113 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 16114 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16115 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 16116 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 16117 return nullptr; 16118 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16119 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16120 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 16121 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16122 else 16123 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 16124 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16125 } 16126 } else { // struct/union 16127 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16128 nullptr); 16129 } 16130 16131 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16132 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 16133 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16134 // 16135 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16136 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16137 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16138 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16139 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16140 // parsing of the struct). 16141 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16142 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16143 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16144 } 16145 } 16146 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16147 return New; 16148 }; 16149 16150 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 16151 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16152 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 16153 16154 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 16155 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 16156 Name = nullptr; 16157 goto CreateNewDecl; 16158 } 16159 16160 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 16161 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 16162 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16163 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 16164 if (!DC) { 16165 IsDependent = true; 16166 return nullptr; 16167 } 16168 } else { 16169 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 16170 if (!DC) { 16171 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 16172 << SS.getRange(); 16173 return nullptr; 16174 } 16175 } 16176 16177 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 16178 return nullptr; 16179 16180 SearchDC = DC; 16181 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 16182 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 16183 16184 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16185 return nullptr; 16186 16187 if (Previous.empty()) { 16188 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 16189 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 16190 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 16191 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 16192 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 16193 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 16194 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 16195 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 16196 IsDependent = true; 16197 return nullptr; 16198 } 16199 16200 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 16201 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 16202 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 16203 Name = nullptr; 16204 Invalid = true; 16205 goto CreateNewDecl; 16206 } 16207 } else if (Name) { 16208 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 16209 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 16210 // name different from T: 16211 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 16212 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16213 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 16214 return nullptr; 16215 16216 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 16217 // declaration or definition. 16218 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 16219 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 16220 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 16221 LookupName(Previous, S); 16222 16223 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 16224 // by types using'ed into this scope. 16225 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 16226 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 16227 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16228 while (F.hasNext()) { 16229 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16230 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 16231 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 16232 F.erase(); 16233 } 16234 F.done(); 16235 } 16236 16237 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 16238 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 16239 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 16240 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 16241 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 16242 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 16243 // 16244 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 16245 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 16246 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 16247 // 16248 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 16249 // semantic context? 16250 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16251 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16252 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16253 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 16254 while (F.hasNext()) { 16255 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16256 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16257 if (DC->isFileContext() && 16258 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 16259 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16260 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 16261 else 16262 F.erase(); 16263 } 16264 } 16265 F.done(); 16266 16267 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 16268 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 16269 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 16270 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16271 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 16272 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 16273 } 16274 } 16275 16276 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 16277 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16278 return nullptr; 16279 16280 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 16281 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 16282 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 16283 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 16284 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 16285 while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16286 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16287 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16288 // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go 16289 // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl 16290 // context. 16291 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16292 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16293 } 16294 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16295 // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous 16296 // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl. 16297 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16298 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16299 } 16300 16301 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 16302 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 16303 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16304 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16305 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16306 Previous.clear(); 16307 } 16308 16309 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 16310 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 16311 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 16312 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 16313 isStdBadAlloc = true; 16314 16315 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 16316 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 16317 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 16318 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 16319 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 16320 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 16321 isStdAlignValT = true; 16322 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 16323 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 16324 } 16325 } 16326 16327 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 16328 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 16329 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 16330 // there's a shadow friend decl. 16331 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 16332 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 16333 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 16334 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 16335 16336 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 16337 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 16338 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 16339 // 16340 // class-key identifier 16341 // 16342 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 16343 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 16344 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 16345 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 16346 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 16347 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 16348 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 16349 // declaration. 16350 // 16351 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 16352 // C structs and unions. 16353 // 16354 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 16355 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 16356 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 16357 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 16358 // 16359 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 16360 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 16361 // 16362 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 16363 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 16364 // lexical context, 16365 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 16366 16367 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 16368 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16369 } else { 16370 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 16371 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 16372 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 16373 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 16374 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 16375 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16376 } 16377 16378 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 16379 // diagnose some problems. 16380 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 16381 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 16382 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 16383 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 16384 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16385 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 16386 // which are meaningless. 16387 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16388 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 16389 } else { 16390 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16391 LookupName(Previous, S); 16392 } 16393 } 16394 16395 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 16396 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 16397 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 16398 16399 if (!Previous.empty()) { 16400 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16401 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16402 16403 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 16404 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 16405 // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++. 16406 // 16407 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 16408 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 16409 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 16410 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 16411 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16412 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16413 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 16414 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 16415 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 16416 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 16417 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 16418 PrevDecl = Tag; 16419 Previous.clear(); 16420 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 16421 Previous.resolveKind(); 16422 } 16423 } 16424 } 16425 } 16426 16427 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 16428 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 16429 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 16430 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 16431 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 16432 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16433 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 16434 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 16435 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 16436 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 16437 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 16438 diag::note_using_decl_target); 16439 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 16440 << 0; 16441 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 16442 Previous.clear(); 16443 goto CreateNewDecl; 16444 } 16445 } 16446 16447 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16448 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 16449 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 16450 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 16451 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 16452 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16453 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16454 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 16455 // struct or something similar. 16456 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 16457 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 16458 Name)) { 16459 bool SafeToContinue 16460 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 16461 Kind != TTK_Enum); 16462 if (SafeToContinue) 16463 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 16464 << Name 16465 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 16466 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 16467 else 16468 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 16469 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16470 16471 if (SafeToContinue) 16472 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 16473 else { 16474 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 16475 Name = nullptr; 16476 Previous.clear(); 16477 Invalid = true; 16478 } 16479 } 16480 16481 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 16482 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 16483 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 16484 return PrevTagDecl; 16485 16486 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 16487 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16488 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 16489 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 16490 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 16491 16492 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 16493 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 16494 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 16495 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 16496 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 16497 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 16498 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 16499 } 16500 16501 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 16502 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 16503 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 16504 // and then later defined. 16505 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 16506 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 16507 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 16508 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16509 } 16510 16511 if (!Invalid) { 16512 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 16513 // we have attributes. 16514 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16515 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 16516 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 16517 // declaration to hold them. 16518 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 16519 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 16520 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 16521 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 16522 SS.isEmpty()) { 16523 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 16524 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 16525 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 16526 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 16527 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 16528 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 16529 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 16530 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 16531 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 16532 return PrevTagDecl; 16533 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 16534 // that scope. 16535 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16536 } else { 16537 return PrevTagDecl; 16538 } 16539 } 16540 16541 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 16542 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16543 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 16544 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 16545 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 16546 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 16547 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 16548 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 16549 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 16550 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16551 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16552 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16553 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 16554 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16555 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16556 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16557 } 16558 16559 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 16560 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 16561 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 16562 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 16563 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 16564 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 16565 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 16566 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 16567 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 16568 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 16569 // use it in place of this one. 16570 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16571 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 16572 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 16573 // comparison. 16574 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 16575 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 16576 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16577 return Def; 16578 } else { 16579 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 16580 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16581 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 16582 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 16583 // skip starting the definitiion later. 16584 } 16585 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 16586 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 16587 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 16588 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 16589 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 16590 else 16591 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 16592 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 16593 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 16594 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 16595 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 16596 // references get the previous definition. 16597 Name = nullptr; 16598 Previous.clear(); 16599 Invalid = true; 16600 } 16601 } else { 16602 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 16603 // about a nested redefinition. 16604 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 16605 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 16606 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 16607 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 16608 diag::note_previous_definition); 16609 Name = nullptr; 16610 Previous.clear(); 16611 Invalid = true; 16612 } 16613 } 16614 16615 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 16616 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 16617 } 16618 16619 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 16620 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 16621 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 16622 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16623 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 16624 AS = AS_none; 16625 } 16626 } 16627 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 16628 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 16629 16630 } else { 16631 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 16632 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 16633 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 16634 // have distinct types. 16635 Previous.clear(); 16636 } 16637 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 16638 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 16639 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 16640 16641 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 16642 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 16643 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 16644 } else { 16645 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 16646 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 16647 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 16648 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 16649 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 16650 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16651 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 16652 << Kind; 16653 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 16654 Invalid = true; 16655 16656 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 16657 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16658 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16659 // do nothing 16660 16661 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 16662 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16663 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16664 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 16665 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16666 Invalid = true; 16667 16668 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 16669 // case here. 16670 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16671 unsigned Kind = 0; 16672 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 16673 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 16674 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 16675 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16676 Invalid = true; 16677 16678 // Otherwise, diagnose. 16679 } else { 16680 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 16681 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 16682 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 16683 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 16684 Name = nullptr; 16685 Invalid = true; 16686 } 16687 16688 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 16689 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 16690 Previous.clear(); 16691 } 16692 } 16693 16694 CreateNewDecl: 16695 16696 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16697 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 16698 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16699 16700 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16701 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16702 // keyword. 16703 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16704 16705 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16706 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16707 // PrevDecl. 16708 TagDecl *New; 16709 16710 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16711 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16712 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16713 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16714 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16715 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16716 16717 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16718 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16719 16720 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16721 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16722 TagDecl *Def; 16723 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16724 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16725 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16726 } 16727 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16728 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16729 << New; 16730 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16731 } else { 16732 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16733 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16734 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16735 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16736 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16737 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16738 } 16739 } 16740 16741 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16742 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16743 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16744 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16745 else 16746 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 16747 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16748 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16749 } 16750 } else { 16751 // struct/union/class 16752 16753 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16754 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16755 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16756 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16757 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16758 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16759 16760 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16761 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16762 } else 16763 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16764 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16765 } 16766 16767 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16768 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16769 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16770 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16771 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16772 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16773 Invalid = true; 16774 } 16775 16776 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16777 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16778 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16779 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16780 Invalid = true; 16781 } 16782 16783 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16784 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16785 if (SS.isSet()) { 16786 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16787 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16788 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16789 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16790 isMemberSpecialization)) 16791 Invalid = true; 16792 16793 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16794 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16795 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16796 } 16797 } 16798 else 16799 Invalid = true; 16800 } 16801 16802 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16803 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16804 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16805 // 16806 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16807 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16808 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16809 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16810 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16811 // parsing of the struct). 16812 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16813 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16814 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16815 } 16816 } 16817 16818 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16819 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16820 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16821 << 2 16822 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16823 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16824 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16825 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16826 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16827 New->setModulePrivate(); 16828 } 16829 16830 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16831 // check the specialization. 16832 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 16833 Invalid = true; 16834 16835 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 16836 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 16837 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 16838 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 16839 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 16840 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16841 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 16842 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 16843 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 16844 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 16845 << Name; 16846 Invalid = true; 16847 } 16848 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 16849 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16850 } 16851 } 16852 16853 if (Invalid) 16854 New->setInvalidDecl(); 16855 16856 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 16857 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 16858 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16859 16860 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 16861 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 16862 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 16863 // the tag name visible. 16864 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 16865 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 16866 16867 // Set the access specifier. 16868 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 16869 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 16870 16871 if (PrevDecl) 16872 CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl); 16873 16874 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 16875 New->startDefinition(); 16876 16877 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 16878 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 16879 16880 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 16881 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16882 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 16883 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 16884 if (PrevDecl) 16885 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 16886 16887 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16888 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 16889 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 16890 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 16891 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 16892 } else if (Name) { 16893 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 16894 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 16895 } else { 16896 CurContext->addDecl(New); 16897 } 16898 16899 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 16900 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 16901 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 16902 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 16903 II->isStr("FILE")) 16904 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 16905 16906 if (PrevDecl) 16907 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 16908 16909 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 16910 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 16911 16912 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16913 // record. 16914 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 16915 16916 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 16917 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 16918 16919 OwnedDecl = true; 16920 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 16921 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 16922 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16923 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 16924 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 16925 RD->completeDefinition(); 16926 return nullptr; 16927 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 16928 return SkipBody->Previous; 16929 } else { 16930 return New; 16931 } 16932 } 16933 16934 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16935 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16936 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16937 16938 // Enter the tag context. 16939 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 16940 16941 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 16942 16943 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16944 // record. 16945 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 16946 } 16947 16948 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 16949 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 16950 return false; 16951 16952 // Make the previous decl visible. 16953 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 16954 return true; 16955 } 16956 16957 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) { 16958 assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 16959 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 16960 CurContext = IDecl; 16961 } 16962 16963 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16964 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 16965 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 16966 bool IsAbstract, 16967 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 16968 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16969 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 16970 16971 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 16972 16973 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 16974 return; 16975 16976 if (IsAbstract) 16977 Record->markAbstract(); 16978 16979 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) { 16980 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 16981 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 16982 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 16983 } 16984 // C++ [class]p2: 16985 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 16986 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 16987 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 16988 // as if it were a public member name. 16989 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 16990 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 16991 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 16992 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 16993 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 16994 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 16995 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 16996 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 16997 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 16998 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 16999 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 17000 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 17001 "Broken injected-class-name"); 17002 } 17003 17004 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 17005 SourceRange BraceRange) { 17006 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17007 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17008 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 17009 17010 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17011 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17012 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 17013 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17014 RD->completeDefinition(); 17015 } 17016 17017 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 17018 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 17019 if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) { 17020 auto *Def = RD->getDefinition(); 17021 assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition"); 17022 unsigned NumInitMethods = 0; 17023 for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) { 17024 if (!Method->getIdentifier()) 17025 continue; 17026 if (Method->getName() == "__init") 17027 NumInitMethods++; 17028 } 17029 if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod()) 17030 Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method); 17031 } 17032 } 17033 17034 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 17035 PopDeclContext(); 17036 17037 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 17038 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 17039 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 17040 17041 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 17042 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 17043 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 17044 17045 // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout 17046 // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior. 17047 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() && 17048 AlignPackStack.hasValue()) { 17049 AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue; 17050 // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed). 17051 if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed) 17052 return; 17053 const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 17054 if (!RD) 17055 return; 17056 // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member. 17057 if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(), 17058 [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); })) 17059 Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible); 17060 } 17061 } 17062 17063 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 17064 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 17065 PopDeclContext(); 17066 } 17067 17068 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17069 assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 17070 OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx; 17071 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 17072 } 17073 17074 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17075 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx); 17076 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 17077 } 17078 17079 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 17080 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17081 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17082 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 17083 17084 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17085 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17086 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17087 RD->completeDefinition(); 17088 } 17089 17090 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 17091 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 17092 // the FieldCollector. 17093 17094 PopDeclContext(); 17095 } 17096 17097 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 17098 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 17099 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy, 17100 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth) { 17101 assert(BitWidth); 17102 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 17103 return ExprError(); 17104 17105 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 17106 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 17107 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 17108 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 17109 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 17110 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 17111 return ExprError(); 17112 if (FieldName) 17113 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 17114 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17115 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 17116 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17117 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 17118 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 17119 return ExprError(); 17120 17121 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 17122 // it now. 17123 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 17124 return BitWidth; 17125 17126 llvm::APSInt Value; 17127 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 17128 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 17129 return ICE; 17130 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 17131 17132 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 17133 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 17134 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 17135 17136 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 17137 if (FieldName) 17138 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17139 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17140 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17141 << toString(Value, 10); 17142 } 17143 17144 // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object 17145 // size. 17146 if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 17147 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide) 17148 << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17149 } 17150 17151 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 17152 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 17153 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 17154 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 17155 17156 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 17157 // ABI. 17158 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 17159 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 17160 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 17161 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 17162 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 17163 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 17164 unsigned DiagWidth = 17165 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 17166 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17167 << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17168 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 17169 } 17170 17171 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 17172 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 17173 // 'bool'. 17174 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) { 17175 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17176 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17177 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 17178 } 17179 } 17180 17181 return BitWidth; 17182 } 17183 17184 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 17185 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 17186 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 17187 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 17188 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 17189 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 17190 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 17191 return Res; 17192 } 17193 17194 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 17195 /// 17196 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 17197 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17198 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 17199 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17200 AccessSpecifier AS) { 17201 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 17202 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 17203 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 17204 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 17205 return nullptr; 17206 } 17207 17208 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17209 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17210 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17211 17212 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17213 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17214 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17215 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 17216 17217 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 17218 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 17219 D.setInvalidType(); 17220 T = Context.IntTy; 17221 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 17222 } 17223 } 17224 17225 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 17226 17227 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 17228 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 17229 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 17230 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 17231 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 17232 diag::err_invalid_thread) 17233 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 17234 17235 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 17236 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 17237 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17238 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17239 LookupName(Previous, S); 17240 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 17241 case LookupResult::Found: 17242 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 17243 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17244 break; 17245 17246 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 17247 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 17248 break; 17249 17250 case LookupResult::NotFound: 17251 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 17252 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 17253 break; 17254 } 17255 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 17256 17257 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17258 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17259 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 17260 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17261 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17262 } 17263 17264 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 17265 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17266 17267 bool Mutable 17268 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 17269 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 17270 FieldDecl *NewFD 17271 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 17272 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 17273 17274 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 17275 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17276 17277 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17278 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 17279 17280 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 17281 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 17282 // with the same name in the same scope. 17283 } else if (II) { 17284 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 17285 } else 17286 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 17287 17288 return NewFD; 17289 } 17290 17291 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 17292 /// 17293 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 17294 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 17295 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 17296 /// created. 17297 /// 17298 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 17299 /// 17300 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 17301 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 17302 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 17303 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 17304 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 17305 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17306 SourceLocation TSSL, 17307 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 17308 Declarator *D) { 17309 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 17310 bool InvalidDecl = false; 17311 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 17312 17313 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 17314 // marking this declaration as invalid. 17315 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 17316 InvalidDecl = true; 17317 T = Context.IntTy; 17318 } 17319 17320 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 17321 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 17322 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 17323 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17324 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 17325 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17326 InvalidDecl = true; 17327 } else { 17328 NamedDecl *Def; 17329 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 17330 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 17331 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17332 InvalidDecl = true; 17333 } 17334 } 17335 } 17336 17337 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 17338 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 17339 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 17340 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 17341 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17342 InvalidDecl = true; 17343 } 17344 17345 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17346 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 17347 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 17348 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 17349 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 17350 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 17351 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17352 InvalidDecl = true; 17353 } 17354 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension 17355 // is enabled. 17356 if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 17357 "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) { 17358 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 17359 InvalidDecl = true; 17360 } 17361 } 17362 17363 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 17364 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 17365 T.hasQualifiers()) { 17366 InvalidDecl = true; 17367 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 17368 } 17369 17370 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17371 // than a variably modified type. 17372 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17373 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17374 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size)) 17375 InvalidDecl = true; 17376 } 17377 17378 // Fields can not have abstract class types 17379 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 17380 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17381 AbstractFieldType)) 17382 InvalidDecl = true; 17383 17384 if (InvalidDecl) 17385 BitWidth = nullptr; 17386 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 17387 if (BitWidth) { 17388 BitWidth = 17389 VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth).get(); 17390 if (!BitWidth) { 17391 InvalidDecl = true; 17392 BitWidth = nullptr; 17393 } 17394 } 17395 17396 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 17397 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 17398 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17399 if (T->isReferenceType()) 17400 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 17401 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 17402 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 17403 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 17404 17405 if (DiagID) { 17406 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 17407 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 17408 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 17409 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 17410 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 17411 Mutable = false; 17412 InvalidDecl = true; 17413 } 17414 } 17415 } 17416 17417 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 17418 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 17419 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 17420 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 17421 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 17422 17423 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 17424 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 17425 if (InvalidDecl) 17426 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17427 17428 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17429 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17430 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17431 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17432 } 17433 17434 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17435 if (Record->isUnion()) { 17436 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17437 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17438 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17439 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 17440 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 17441 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 17442 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 17443 // objects. 17444 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 17445 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17446 } 17447 } 17448 17449 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 17450 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 17451 // enabled. 17452 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 17453 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 17454 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 17455 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 17456 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 17457 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 17458 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17459 } 17460 } 17461 } 17462 17463 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 17464 // representation, not a parser representation. 17465 if (D) { 17466 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 17467 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 17468 17469 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 17470 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 17471 } 17472 17473 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 17474 // retainable type. 17475 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 17476 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17477 17478 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 17479 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 17480 17481 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 17482 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 17483 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 17484 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17485 17486 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 17487 return NewFD; 17488 } 17489 17490 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 17491 assert(FD); 17492 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 17493 17494 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 17495 return false; 17496 17497 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17498 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17499 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17500 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17501 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 17502 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 17503 // copy constructors. 17504 17505 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 17506 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 17507 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 17508 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 17509 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 17510 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 17511 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 17512 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 17513 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 17514 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 17515 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 17516 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 17517 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 17518 member = CXXDestructor; 17519 17520 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 17521 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 17522 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 17523 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 17524 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 17525 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 17526 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 17527 // members unavailable. 17528 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17529 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 17530 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 17531 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 17532 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 17533 return false; 17534 } 17535 } 17536 17537 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 17538 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 17539 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 17540 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 17541 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 17542 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 17543 } 17544 } 17545 } 17546 17547 return false; 17548 } 17549 17550 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 17551 /// AST enum value. 17552 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 17553 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 17554 switch (ivarVisibility) { 17555 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 17556 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 17557 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 17558 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 17559 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 17560 } 17561 } 17562 17563 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 17564 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 17565 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 17566 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17567 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 17568 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 17569 17570 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17571 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 17572 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17573 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17574 17575 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 17576 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 17577 17578 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17579 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17580 17581 if (BitWidth) { 17582 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 17583 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 17584 if (!BitWidth) 17585 D.setInvalidType(); 17586 } else { 17587 // Not a bitfield. 17588 17589 // validate II. 17590 17591 } 17592 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 17593 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 17594 D.setInvalidType(); 17595 } 17596 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17597 // than a variably modified type. 17598 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17599 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17600 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size)) 17601 D.setInvalidType(); 17602 } 17603 17604 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 17605 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 17606 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 17607 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 17608 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 17609 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 17610 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 17611 return nullptr; 17612 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 17613 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17614 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17615 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 17616 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 17617 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 17618 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 17619 } 17620 else 17621 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17622 } else { 17623 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17624 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17625 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 17626 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 17627 return nullptr; 17628 } 17629 } 17630 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17631 } 17632 17633 // Construct the decl. 17634 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 17635 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 17636 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 17637 17638 if (II) { 17639 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17640 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17641 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 17642 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17643 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17644 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17645 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17646 } 17647 } 17648 17649 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 17650 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 17651 17652 if (D.isInvalidType()) 17653 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17654 17655 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 17656 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 17657 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17658 17659 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17660 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 17661 17662 if (II) { 17663 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 17664 // these to the interface. 17665 S->AddDecl(NewID); 17666 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 17667 } 17668 17669 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 17670 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 17671 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 17672 17673 return NewID; 17674 } 17675 17676 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 17677 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 17678 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 17679 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 17680 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 17681 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 17682 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 17683 return; 17684 17685 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 17686 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 17687 17688 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17689 return; 17690 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 17691 if (!ID) { 17692 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 17693 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 17694 return; 17695 } 17696 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 17697 else 17698 return; 17699 } 17700 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 17701 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 17702 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17703 17704 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17705 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17706 Context.CharTy, 17707 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17708 DeclLoc), 17709 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17710 true); 17711 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17712 } 17713 17714 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17715 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17716 SourceLocation RBrac, 17717 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17718 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17719 17720 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17721 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17722 // it will now change. 17723 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17724 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17725 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17726 default: break; 17727 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17728 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17729 break; 17730 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17731 Context. 17732 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17733 break; 17734 } 17735 } 17736 17737 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17738 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17739 17740 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17741 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17742 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17743 if (Record) { 17744 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17745 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17746 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17747 ++NumNamedMembers; 17748 } 17749 } 17750 17751 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17752 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17753 17754 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17755 i != end; ++i) { 17756 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17757 17758 // Get the type for the field. 17759 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 17760 17761 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 17762 // Remember all fields written by the user. 17763 RecFields.push_back(FD); 17764 } 17765 17766 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 17767 // diagnostics about it. 17768 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 17769 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17770 continue; 17771 } 17772 17773 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 17774 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 17775 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 17776 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 17777 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 17778 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 17779 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 17780 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 17781 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 17782 // array. 17783 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 17784 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 17785 // Field declared as a function. 17786 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 17787 << FD->getDeclName(); 17788 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17789 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17790 continue; 17791 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 17792 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 17793 if (Record) { 17794 // Flexible array member. 17795 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 17796 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 17797 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 17798 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17799 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 17800 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 17801 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 17802 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 17803 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17804 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17805 continue; 17806 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 17807 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17808 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 17809 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17810 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 17811 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 17812 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 17813 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17814 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 17815 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17816 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 17817 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 17818 17819 if (DiagID) 17820 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 17821 << Record->getTagKind(); 17822 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 17823 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 17824 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 17825 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 17826 // of the type. 17827 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 17828 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 17829 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17830 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 17831 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 17832 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17833 17834 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 17835 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 17836 // 17837 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 17838 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 17839 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17840 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 17841 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 17842 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17843 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17844 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17845 continue; 17846 } 17847 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 17848 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17849 } else { 17850 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 17851 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 17852 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 17853 } 17854 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 17855 RequireCompleteSizedType( 17856 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17857 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17858 // Incomplete type 17859 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17860 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17861 continue; 17862 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17863 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 17864 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 17865 // flexible array member. 17866 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17867 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 17868 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 17869 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 17870 // structures. 17871 if (!IsLastField) 17872 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 17873 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17874 else { 17875 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 17876 // other structs as an extension. 17877 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 17878 << FD->getDeclName(); 17879 } 17880 } 17881 } 17882 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 17883 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17884 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17885 AbstractIvarType)) { 17886 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 17887 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17888 } 17889 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17890 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17891 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 17892 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17893 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 17894 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 17895 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 17896 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 17897 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 17898 FD->setType(T); 17899 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 17900 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 17901 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 17902 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 17903 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 17904 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 17905 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 17906 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 17907 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 17908 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 17909 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 17910 // ARC. 17911 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 17912 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 17913 FD->getLocation())); 17914 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 17915 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 17916 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 17917 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17918 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 17919 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17920 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 17921 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17922 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 17923 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17924 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17925 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17926 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 17927 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17928 } 17929 } 17930 17931 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17932 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 17933 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 17934 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 17935 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 17936 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 17937 Record->isUnion()) 17938 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 17939 } 17940 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 17941 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 17942 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 17943 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17944 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 17945 } 17946 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 17947 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 17948 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 17949 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17950 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 17951 } 17952 17953 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17954 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 17955 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 17956 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17957 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 17958 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17959 } 17960 17961 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 17962 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17963 // Keep track of the number of named members. 17964 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 17965 ++NumNamedMembers; 17966 } 17967 17968 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 17969 if (Record) { 17970 bool Completed = false; 17971 if (CXXRecord) { 17972 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17973 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 17974 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 17975 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 17976 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 17977 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 17978 } 17979 17980 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 17981 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 17982 17983 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 17984 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17985 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 17986 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 17987 // problem now. 17988 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 17989 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 17990 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 17991 17992 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 17993 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 17994 M != MEnd; ++M) { 17995 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 17996 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 17997 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 17998 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 17999 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 18000 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 18001 continue; 18002 18003 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 18004 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 18005 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 18006 // program is ill-formed. 18007 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 18008 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 18009 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 18010 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 18011 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 18012 OM = SO->second.begin(), 18013 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 18014 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 18015 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 18016 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 18017 18018 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 18019 } 18020 } 18021 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 18022 Completed = true; 18023 } 18024 } 18025 } 18026 } 18027 18028 if (!Completed) 18029 Record->completeDefinition(); 18030 18031 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 18032 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 18033 18034 // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function. 18035 auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) { 18036 const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 18037 if (!FD) 18038 return false; 18039 QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context); 18040 if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) { 18041 QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType(); 18042 return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType(); 18043 } 18044 return false; 18045 }; 18046 18047 // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record 18048 // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute. 18049 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18050 (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() || 18051 (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() && 18052 llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) && 18053 !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() && 18054 !Record->isRandomized()) { 18055 SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering; 18056 if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record, 18057 NewDeclOrdering)) 18058 Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering); 18059 } 18060 18061 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 18062 if (CXXRecord) { 18063 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 18064 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 18065 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 18066 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 18067 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 18068 } 18069 } 18070 18071 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 18072 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 18073 18074 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 18075 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 18076 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 18077 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 18078 } 18079 18080 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 18081 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 18082 // compatibility problems. 18083 bool CheckForZeroSize; 18084 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18085 CheckForZeroSize = true; 18086 } else { 18087 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 18088 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 18089 CheckForZeroSize = 18090 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 18091 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 18092 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 18093 } 18094 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 18095 bool ZeroSize = true; 18096 bool IsEmpty = true; 18097 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 18098 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 18099 E = Record->field_end(); 18100 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 18101 IsEmpty = false; 18102 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 18103 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 18104 ZeroSize = false; 18105 } else { 18106 ++NonBitFields; 18107 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 18108 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 18109 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 18110 ZeroSize = false; 18111 } 18112 } 18113 18114 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 18115 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 18116 // extern "C" block. 18117 if (ZeroSize) { 18118 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 18119 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 18120 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 18121 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 18122 } 18123 18124 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 18125 // but are accepted by GCC. 18126 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18127 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 18128 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 18129 << Record->isUnion(); 18130 } 18131 } 18132 } else { 18133 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 18134 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 18135 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18136 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 18137 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 18138 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18139 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 18140 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18141 } 18142 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 18143 // duplicates. 18144 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 18145 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 18146 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 18147 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18148 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 18149 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 18150 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 18151 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 18152 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 18153 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 18154 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18155 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18156 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 18157 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18158 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 18159 // reported as errors elsewhere. 18160 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 18161 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 18162 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 18163 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 18164 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 18165 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18166 if (IDecl) { 18167 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 18168 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18169 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18170 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18171 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18172 continue; 18173 } 18174 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 18175 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 18176 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18177 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18178 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18179 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18180 continue; 18181 } 18182 } 18183 } 18184 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 18185 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18186 } 18187 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18188 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18189 } 18190 } 18191 } 18192 18193 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 18194 /// the given type T. 18195 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 18196 llvm::APSInt &Value, 18197 QualType T) { 18198 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 18199 "Integral type required!"); 18200 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 18201 18202 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 18203 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 18204 --BitWidth; 18205 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 18206 } 18207 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 18208 } 18209 18210 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 18211 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 18212 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 18213 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 18214 // enum checking below. 18215 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 18216 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 18217 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 18218 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18219 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 18220 }; 18221 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18222 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 18223 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 18224 }; 18225 18226 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 18227 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 18228 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 18229 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 18230 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 18231 return Types[I]; 18232 18233 return QualType(); 18234 } 18235 18236 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 18237 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 18238 SourceLocation IdLoc, 18239 IdentifierInfo *Id, 18240 Expr *Val) { 18241 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18242 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 18243 QualType EltTy; 18244 18245 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 18246 Val = nullptr; 18247 18248 if (Val) 18249 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 18250 18251 if (Val) { 18252 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() || 18253 Val->containsErrors()) 18254 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18255 else { 18256 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 18257 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 18258 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 18259 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 18260 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 18261 // constant expression of the underlying type. 18262 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18263 ExprResult Converted = 18264 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 18265 CCEK_Enumerator); 18266 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 18267 Val = nullptr; 18268 else 18269 Val = Converted.get(); 18270 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 18271 !(Val = 18272 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 18273 .get())) { 18274 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 18275 } else { 18276 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18277 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18278 18279 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 18280 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 18281 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 18282 // expression checking. 18283 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18284 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 18285 .getTriple() 18286 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 18287 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18288 } else { 18289 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18290 } 18291 } 18292 18293 // Cast to the underlying type. 18294 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 18295 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 18296 : CK_IntegralCast) 18297 .get(); 18298 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18299 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 18300 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18301 // is the type of its initializing value: 18302 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 18303 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 18304 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18305 } else { 18306 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 18307 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 18308 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 18309 // representable as an int. 18310 18311 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 18312 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 18313 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18314 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange() 18315 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 18316 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 18317 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 18318 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 18319 } 18320 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18321 } 18322 } 18323 } 18324 } 18325 18326 if (!Val) { 18327 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 18328 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18329 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 18330 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18331 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18332 // is the type of its initializing value: 18333 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 18334 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 18335 // 18336 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 18337 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 18338 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 18339 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18340 } 18341 else { 18342 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 18343 } 18344 } else { 18345 // Assign the last value + 1. 18346 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18347 ++EnumVal; 18348 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 18349 18350 // Check for overflow on increment. 18351 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 18352 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18353 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18354 // is the type of its initializing value: 18355 // 18356 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 18357 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 18358 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 18359 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 18360 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 18361 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 18362 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 18363 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 18364 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 18365 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 18366 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18367 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 18368 ++EnumVal; 18369 if (Enum->isFixed()) 18370 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 18371 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 18372 << toString(EnumVal, 10) 18373 << EltTy; 18374 else 18375 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 18376 << toString(EnumVal, 10); 18377 } else { 18378 EltTy = T; 18379 } 18380 18381 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 18382 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 18383 // value, then increment. 18384 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18385 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18386 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18387 ++EnumVal; 18388 18389 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 18390 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 18391 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 18392 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 18393 // integral type. 18394 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 18395 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 18396 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18397 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18398 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 18399 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18400 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1; 18401 } 18402 } 18403 } 18404 18405 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 18406 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 18407 // enumerator's type. 18408 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18409 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18410 } 18411 18412 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 18413 Val, EnumVal); 18414 } 18415 18416 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 18417 SourceLocation IILoc) { 18418 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 18419 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18420 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18421 18422 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 18423 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 18424 // skip the body. 18425 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 18426 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 18427 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 18428 if (!PrevECD) 18429 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18430 18431 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 18432 NamedDecl *Hidden; 18433 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 18434 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 18435 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 18436 return Skip; 18437 } 18438 18439 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18440 } 18441 18442 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 18443 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 18444 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 18445 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 18446 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 18447 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 18448 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 18449 18450 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 18451 // we find one that is. 18452 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 18453 18454 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 18455 // scope. 18456 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 18457 LookupName(R, S); 18458 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 18459 18460 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 18461 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 18462 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 18463 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 18464 PrevDecl = nullptr; 18465 } 18466 18467 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 18468 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 18469 // different from T: 18470 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 18471 // enumerated type 18472 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 18473 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 18474 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 18475 18476 EnumConstantDecl *New = 18477 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 18478 if (!New) 18479 return nullptr; 18480 18481 if (PrevDecl) { 18482 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 18483 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 18484 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 18485 } 18486 18487 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 18488 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 18489 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 18490 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 18491 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 18492 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18493 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 18494 else 18495 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 18496 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 18497 return nullptr; 18498 } 18499 } 18500 18501 // Process attributes. 18502 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 18503 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 18504 18505 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 18506 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 18507 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 18508 18509 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 18510 18511 return New; 18512 } 18513 18514 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 18515 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 18516 // Element2 = Element1 18517 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 18518 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 18519 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 18520 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 18521 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 18522 if (!InitExpr) 18523 return true; 18524 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 18525 18526 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 18527 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 18528 return true; 18529 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 18530 if (!IL) 18531 return true; 18532 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 18533 return true; 18534 18535 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 18536 } 18537 18538 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 18539 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 18540 if (!DRE) 18541 return true; 18542 18543 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 18544 if (!EnumConstant) 18545 return true; 18546 18547 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 18548 Enum) 18549 return true; 18550 18551 return false; 18552 } 18553 18554 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 18555 // a previous element has already been set to. 18556 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 18557 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 18558 // Avoid anonymous enums 18559 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 18560 return; 18561 18562 // Only check for small enums. 18563 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 18564 return; 18565 18566 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 18567 return; 18568 18569 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 18570 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 18571 18572 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 18573 18574 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 18575 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 18576 18577 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 18578 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 18579 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 18580 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 18581 }; 18582 18583 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 18584 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 18585 18586 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 18587 // an initializer. 18588 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18589 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18590 18591 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 18592 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 18593 if (!ECD) { 18594 return; 18595 } 18596 18597 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 18598 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 18599 continue; 18600 18601 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 18602 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 18603 } 18604 18605 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 18606 return; 18607 18608 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 18609 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18610 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 18611 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18612 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 18613 continue; 18614 18615 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 18616 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 18617 continue; 18618 18619 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 18620 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 18621 // Ensure constants are different. 18622 if (D == ECD) 18623 continue; 18624 18625 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 18626 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 18627 Vec->push_back(D); 18628 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18629 18630 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 18631 Entry = Vec.get(); 18632 18633 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 18634 // diagnostics. 18635 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 18636 continue; 18637 } 18638 18639 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 18640 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 18641 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 18642 continue; 18643 18644 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18645 } 18646 18647 // Emit diagnostics. 18648 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 18649 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 18650 18651 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 18652 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 18653 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 18654 << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18655 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 18656 18657 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 18658 // the same value. 18659 for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec)) 18660 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 18661 << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18662 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 18663 } 18664 } 18665 18666 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 18667 bool AllowMask) const { 18668 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 18669 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 18670 18671 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 18672 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 18673 18674 if (R.second) { 18675 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 18676 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 18677 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 18678 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 18679 FlagBits = FlagBits.zext(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 18680 } 18681 } 18682 18683 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 18684 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 18685 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 18686 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 18687 // 18688 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 18689 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 18690 // likely a logic error. 18691 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 18692 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 18693 } 18694 18695 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 18696 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 18697 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 18698 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 18699 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 18700 18701 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 18702 18703 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 18704 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18705 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18706 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18707 if (!ECD) continue; 18708 18709 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18710 } 18711 18712 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 18713 return; 18714 } 18715 18716 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 18717 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 18718 // emit a warning. 18719 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18720 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 18721 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 18722 18723 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 18724 // reverse the list. 18725 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 18726 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 18727 18728 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18729 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18730 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18731 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18732 18733 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18734 18735 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18736 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 18737 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 18738 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 18739 else 18740 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18741 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18742 } 18743 18744 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18745 QualType BestType; 18746 unsigned BestWidth; 18747 18748 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18749 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 18750 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 18751 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 18752 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 18753 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 18754 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 18755 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 18756 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 18757 QualType BestPromotionType; 18758 18759 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 18760 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 18761 // enum definitions. 18762 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 18763 Packed = true; 18764 18765 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 18766 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 18767 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18768 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18769 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 18770 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 18771 else 18772 BestPromotionType = BestType; 18773 18774 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 18775 } 18776 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 18777 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 18778 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 18779 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18780 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 18781 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 18782 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18783 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 18784 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 18785 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 18786 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18787 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 18788 BestType = Context.IntTy; 18789 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18790 } else { 18791 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 18792 18793 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 18794 BestType = Context.LongTy; 18795 } else { 18796 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18797 18798 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 18799 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 18800 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 18801 } 18802 } 18803 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 18804 } else { 18805 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 18806 // all of the enumerator values. 18807 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18808 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 18809 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 18810 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18811 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18812 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 18813 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 18814 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18815 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18816 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 18817 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 18818 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18819 BestPromotionType 18820 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18821 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 18822 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 18823 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 18824 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 18825 BestPromotionType 18826 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18827 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 18828 } else { 18829 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18830 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 18831 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 18832 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 18833 BestPromotionType 18834 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18835 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 18836 } 18837 } 18838 18839 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 18840 // the type of the enum if needed. 18841 for (auto *D : Elements) { 18842 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18843 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18844 18845 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 18846 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 18847 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 18848 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 18849 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 18850 18851 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 18852 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18853 18854 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 18855 // the enum decl type. 18856 QualType NewTy; 18857 unsigned NewWidth; 18858 bool NewSign; 18859 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18860 !Enum->isFixed() && 18861 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 18862 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 18863 NewWidth = IntWidth; 18864 NewSign = true; 18865 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 18866 // Already the right type! 18867 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18868 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18869 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18870 // enumeration. 18871 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18872 continue; 18873 } else { 18874 NewTy = BestType; 18875 NewWidth = BestWidth; 18876 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 18877 } 18878 18879 // Adjust the APSInt value. 18880 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 18881 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 18882 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 18883 18884 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 18885 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 18886 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 18887 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 18888 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 18889 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 18890 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18891 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18892 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18893 // enumeration. 18894 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18895 else 18896 ECD->setType(NewTy); 18897 } 18898 18899 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 18900 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 18901 18902 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 18903 18904 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 18905 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 18906 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18907 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18908 18909 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18910 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 18911 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 18912 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 18913 << ECD << Enum; 18914 } 18915 } 18916 18917 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 18918 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 18919 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 18920 } 18921 18922 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 18923 SourceLocation StartLoc, 18924 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 18925 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 18926 18927 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 18928 AsmString, StartLoc, 18929 EndLoc); 18930 CurContext->addDecl(New); 18931 return New; 18932 } 18933 18934 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18935 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18936 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18937 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18938 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18939 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 18940 LookupOrdinaryName); 18941 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 18942 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 18943 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 18944 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 18945 18946 // If a declaration that: 18947 // 1) declares a function or a variable 18948 // 2) has external linkage 18949 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 18950 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18951 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 18952 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 18953 else 18954 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 18955 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 18956 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 18957 } else 18958 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 18959 } 18960 18961 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18962 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18963 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 18964 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 18965 18966 if (PrevDecl) { 18967 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 18968 } else { 18969 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc)); 18970 } 18971 } 18972 18973 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18974 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18975 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18976 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18977 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18978 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 18979 LookupOrdinaryName); 18980 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 18981 18982 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18983 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 18984 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18985 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 18986 } else { 18987 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W); 18988 } 18989 } 18990 18991 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 18992 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 18993 } 18994 18995 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 18996 bool Final) { 18997 assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl"); 18998 18999 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 19000 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 19001 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 19002 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19003 19004 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 19005 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 19006 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 19007 19008 // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition. 19009 auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() { 19010 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 19011 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 19012 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 19013 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 19014 19015 return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage( 19016 getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)); 19017 }; 19018 19019 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 19020 // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions 19021 // we don't need due to their linkage. 19022 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19023 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19024 // DevTy may be changed later by 19025 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). 19026 // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status 19027 // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true. 19028 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 19029 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 19030 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19031 // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target 19032 // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols. 19033 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy.hasValue()) 19034 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19035 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19036 // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed, 19037 // we'll omit it. 19038 if (Final) 19039 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19040 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) { 19041 // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host 19042 // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to 19043 // be ommitted. 19044 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19045 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19046 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 19047 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) 19048 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19049 } 19050 19051 if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA) 19052 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19053 19054 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 19055 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 19056 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 19057 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 19058 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 19059 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 19060 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 19061 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19062 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19063 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 19064 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19065 19066 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19067 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19068 } 19069 19070 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 19071 // known-emitted functions. 19072 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 19073 } 19074 19075 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 19076 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 19077 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 19078 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 19079 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 19080 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 19081 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 19082 // known-emitted. 19083 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19084 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 19085 } 19086